* ada-lang.c: Apply some corrections to the previous comment addition.
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / ada-lang.c
1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger. Copyright (C)
2
3 1992, 1993, 1994, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007, 2008,
4 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GDB.
7
8 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
12
13 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include <stdio.h>
24 #include "gdb_string.h"
25 #include <ctype.h>
26 #include <stdarg.h>
27 #include "demangle.h"
28 #include "gdb_regex.h"
29 #include "frame.h"
30 #include "symtab.h"
31 #include "gdbtypes.h"
32 #include "gdbcmd.h"
33 #include "expression.h"
34 #include "parser-defs.h"
35 #include "language.h"
36 #include "c-lang.h"
37 #include "inferior.h"
38 #include "symfile.h"
39 #include "objfiles.h"
40 #include "breakpoint.h"
41 #include "gdbcore.h"
42 #include "hashtab.h"
43 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
44 #include "ada-lang.h"
45 #include "completer.h"
46 #include "gdb_stat.h"
47 #ifdef UI_OUT
48 #include "ui-out.h"
49 #endif
50 #include "block.h"
51 #include "infcall.h"
52 #include "dictionary.h"
53 #include "exceptions.h"
54 #include "annotate.h"
55 #include "valprint.h"
56 #include "source.h"
57 #include "observer.h"
58 #include "vec.h"
59
60 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
61 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
62 Copied from valarith.c. */
63
64 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
65 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
66 #endif
67
68 static void extract_string (CORE_ADDR addr, char *buf);
69
70 static void modify_general_field (struct type *, char *, LONGEST, int, int);
71
72 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
73
74 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
75
76 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
77
78 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
79
80 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
81
82 static struct type *desc_data_target_type (struct type *);
83
84 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
85
86 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
87
88 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
89
90 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
91
92 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
93
94 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
95
96 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
97
98 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
99
100 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
101
102 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
103
104 static struct value *ensure_lval (struct value *,
105 struct gdbarch *, CORE_ADDR *);
106
107 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *,
108 struct gdbarch *, CORE_ADDR *);
109
110 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
111 struct block *, const char *,
112 domain_enum, struct objfile *, int);
113
114 static int is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info *, int);
115
116 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
117 struct block *);
118
119 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
120
121 static struct ada_symbol_info *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
122
123 static struct partial_symbol *ada_lookup_partial_symbol (struct partial_symtab
124 *, const char *, int,
125 domain_enum, int);
126
127 static struct value *resolve_subexp (struct expression **, int *, int,
128 struct type *);
129
130 static void replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **, int, int, int,
131 struct symbol *, struct block *);
132
133 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
134
135 static char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
136
137 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
138
139 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
140
141 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
142
143 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
144
145 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
146
147 static enum ada_renaming_category parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *,
148 const char **,
149 int *,
150 const char **);
151
152 static struct symbol *find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *,
153 struct block *);
154
155 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, char *,
156 int, int, int *);
157
158 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
159
160 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
161
162 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
163 const gdb_byte *,
164 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
165
166 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
167
168 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (char *, struct value *,
169 struct type *);
170
171 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
172 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
173
174 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
175
176 static struct type *constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
177
178 static struct type *decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
179
180 static long decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *);
181
182 static struct value *decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *);
183
184 static int ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *);
185
186 static int ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
187
188 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
189 struct value **);
190
191 static void move_bits (gdb_byte *, int, const gdb_byte *, int, int, int);
192
193 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
194 struct type *);
195
196 static struct value *get_var_value (char *, char *);
197
198 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
199
200 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
201
202 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
203
204 static int wild_match (const char *, int, const char *);
205
206 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
207
208 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
209
210 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
211
212 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
213
214 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
215 domain_enum);
216
217 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (char *, struct value *, int,
218 struct type *);
219
220 static struct value *ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *, int, int,
221 struct type *);
222
223 static int find_struct_field (char *, struct type *, int,
224 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
225
226 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *, CORE_ADDR,
227 struct value *);
228
229 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *);
230
231 static int ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info *, int,
232 struct value **, int, const char *,
233 struct type *);
234
235 static struct value *ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *);
236
237 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
238
239 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *,
240 struct language_arch_info *);
241
242 static void check_size (const struct type *);
243
244 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
245 struct type *);
246
247 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
248 struct expression *, int *, enum noside);
249
250 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
251 struct expression *,
252 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
253 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
254
255 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
256 struct expression *,
257 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
258 LONGEST, LONGEST);
259
260
261 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
262 struct expression *,
263 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
264
265
266 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
267
268
269 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
270 int *, enum noside);
271
272 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
273 int *);
274 \f
275
276
277 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
278 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
279
280 /* FIXME: brobecker/2003-09-17: No longer a const because it is
281 returned by a function that does not return a const char *. */
282 static char *ada_completer_word_break_characters =
283 #ifdef VMS
284 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
285 #else
286 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
287 #endif
288
289 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
290 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
291 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
292
293 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
294 static int warning_limit = 2;
295
296 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
297 expression evaluation. */
298 static int warnings_issued = 0;
299
300 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
301 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
302 };
303
304 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
305 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
306 };
307
308 /* Space for allocating results of ada_lookup_symbol_list. */
309 static struct obstack symbol_list_obstack;
310
311 /* Utilities */
312
313 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
314 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
315 its unqualified name. */
316
317 static const char *
318 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
319 {
320 const char *result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
321
322 if (result != NULL)
323 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
324 else
325 result = decoded_name;
326
327 return result;
328 }
329
330 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'.
331 The result is good until the next call. */
332
333 static char *
334 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
335 {
336 static char *result = NULL;
337
338 xfree (result);
339 result = xstrprintf ("<%s>", str);
340 return result;
341 }
342
343 static char *
344 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
345 {
346 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
347 }
348
349 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
350
351 static void
352 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream,
353 const struct value_print_options *options)
354 {
355 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options);
356 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
357 }
358
359 /* Read the string located at ADDR from the inferior and store the
360 result into BUF. */
361
362 static void
363 extract_string (CORE_ADDR addr, char *buf)
364 {
365 int char_index = 0;
366
367 /* Loop, reading one byte at a time, until we reach the '\000'
368 end-of-string marker. */
369 do
370 {
371 target_read_memory (addr + char_index * sizeof (char),
372 buf + char_index * sizeof (char), sizeof (char));
373 char_index++;
374 }
375 while (buf[char_index - 1] != '\000');
376 }
377
378 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
379 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
380 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
381
382 void *
383 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
384 {
385 if (*size < min_size)
386 {
387 *size *= 2;
388 if (*size < min_size)
389 *size = min_size;
390 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
391 }
392 return vect;
393 }
394
395 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
396 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
397
398 static int
399 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
400 {
401 int len = strlen (target);
402 return
403 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
404 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
405 || (strncmp (field_name + len, "___", 3) == 0
406 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
407 "___XVN") != 0)));
408 }
409
410
411 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to
412 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME,
413 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name
414 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name
415 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints.
416 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if
417 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
418
419 int
420 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
421 int maybe_missing)
422 {
423 int fieldno;
424 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type);
425
426 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (struct_type); fieldno++)
427 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name))
428 return fieldno;
429
430 if (!maybe_missing)
431 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
432 field_name, TYPE_NAME (struct_type));
433
434 return -1;
435 }
436
437 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
438
439 int
440 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
441 {
442 if (name == NULL)
443 return 0;
444 else
445 {
446 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
447 if (p == NULL)
448 return strlen (name);
449 else
450 return p - name;
451 }
452 }
453
454 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
455 Return zero if STR is null. */
456
457 static int
458 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
459 {
460 int len1, len2;
461 if (str == NULL)
462 return 0;
463 len1 = strlen (str);
464 len2 = strlen (suffix);
465 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
466 }
467
468 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
469 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
470
471 static struct value *
472 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
473 {
474 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
475 if (value_type (val) == type)
476 return val;
477 else
478 {
479 struct value *result;
480
481 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
482 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
483 check_size (type);
484
485 result = allocate_value (type);
486 set_value_component_location (result, val);
487 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
488 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
489 set_value_address (result, value_address (val));
490 if (value_lazy (val)
491 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
492 set_value_lazy (result, 1);
493 else
494 memcpy (value_contents_raw (result), value_contents (val),
495 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
496 return result;
497 }
498 }
499
500 static const gdb_byte *
501 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
502 {
503 if (valaddr == NULL)
504 return NULL;
505 else
506 return valaddr + offset;
507 }
508
509 static CORE_ADDR
510 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
511 {
512 if (address == 0)
513 return 0;
514 else
515 return address + offset;
516 }
517
518 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
519 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
520 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
521 expression. */
522
523 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
524 provided by "complaint". */
525 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTR_FORMAT (printf, 1, 2);
526
527 static void
528 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
529 {
530 va_list args;
531 va_start (args, format);
532
533 warnings_issued += 1;
534 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
535 vwarning (format, args);
536
537 va_end (args);
538 }
539
540 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
541 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
542 GDB. */
543
544 static void
545 check_size (const struct type *type)
546 {
547 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
548 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
549 }
550
551
552 /* Note: would have used MAX_OF_TYPE and MIN_OF_TYPE macros from
553 gdbtypes.h, but some of the necessary definitions in that file
554 seem to have gone missing. */
555
556 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
557 static LONGEST
558 max_of_size (int size)
559 {
560 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
561 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
562 }
563
564 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
565 static LONGEST
566 min_of_size (int size)
567 {
568 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
569 }
570
571 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
572 static ULONGEST
573 umax_of_size (int size)
574 {
575 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
576 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
577 }
578
579 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
580 static LONGEST
581 max_of_type (struct type *t)
582 {
583 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
584 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
585 else
586 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
587 }
588
589 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
590 static LONGEST
591 min_of_type (struct type *t)
592 {
593 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
594 return 0;
595 else
596 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
597 }
598
599 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
600 static LONGEST
601 discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
602 {
603 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
604 {
605 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
606 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type);
607 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
608 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1);
609 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
610 return 1;
611 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
612 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
613 return max_of_type (type);
614 default:
615 error (_("Unexpected type in discrete_type_high_bound."));
616 }
617 }
618
619 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
620 static LONGEST
621 discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
622 {
623 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
624 {
625 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
626 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type);
627 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
628 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, 0);
629 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
630 return 0;
631 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
632 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
633 return min_of_type (type);
634 default:
635 error (_("Unexpected type in discrete_type_low_bound."));
636 }
637 }
638
639 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
640 non-range scalar type. */
641
642 static struct type *
643 base_type (struct type *type)
644 {
645 while (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
646 {
647 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
648 return type;
649 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
650 }
651 return type;
652 }
653 \f
654
655 /* Language Selection */
656
657 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
658 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found).
659
660 MAIN_PST is not used. */
661
662 enum language
663 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang,
664 struct partial_symtab *main_pst)
665 {
666 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", (const char *) NULL,
667 (struct objfile *) NULL) != NULL)
668 return language_ada;
669
670 return lang;
671 }
672
673 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
674 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
675 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
676
677 char *
678 ada_main_name (void)
679 {
680 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
681 static char *main_program_name = NULL;
682
683 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
684 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
685 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
686 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
687 in Ada. */
688 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
689
690 if (msym != NULL)
691 {
692 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
693 int err_code;
694
695 main_program_name_addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
696 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
697 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
698
699 xfree (main_program_name);
700 target_read_string (main_program_name_addr, &main_program_name,
701 1024, &err_code);
702
703 if (err_code != 0)
704 return NULL;
705 return main_program_name;
706 }
707
708 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
709 return NULL;
710 }
711 \f
712 /* Symbols */
713
714 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
715 of NULLs. */
716
717 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
718 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
719 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
720 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
721 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
722 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
723 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
724 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
725 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
726 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
727 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
728 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
729 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
730 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
731 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
732 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
733 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
734 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
735 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
736 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
737 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
738 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
739 {NULL, NULL}
740 };
741
742 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
743 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
744
745 char *
746 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
747 {
748 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
749 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
750 const char *p;
751 int k;
752
753 if (decoded == NULL)
754 return NULL;
755
756 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
757 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
758
759 k = 0;
760 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
761 {
762 if (*p == '.')
763 {
764 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
765 k += 2;
766 }
767 else if (*p == '"')
768 {
769 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
770
771 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
772 mapping->encoded != NULL
773 && strncmp (mapping->decoded, p,
774 strlen (mapping->decoded)) != 0; mapping += 1)
775 ;
776 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
777 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
778 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
779 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
780 break;
781 }
782 else
783 {
784 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
785 k += 1;
786 }
787 }
788
789 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
790 return encoding_buffer;
791 }
792
793 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
794 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
795 to next call. */
796
797 char *
798 ada_fold_name (const char *name)
799 {
800 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
801 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
802
803 int len = strlen (name);
804 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
805
806 if (name[0] == '\'')
807 {
808 strncpy (fold_buffer, name + 1, len - 2);
809 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
810 }
811 else
812 {
813 int i;
814 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
815 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
816 }
817
818 return fold_buffer;
819 }
820
821 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
822
823 static int
824 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
825 {
826 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
827 }
828
829 /* Remove either of these suffixes:
830 . .{DIGIT}+
831 . ${DIGIT}+
832 . ___{DIGIT}+
833 . __{DIGIT}+.
834 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
835 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
836 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
837
838 static void
839 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
840 {
841 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
842 {
843 int i = *len - 2;
844 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
845 i--;
846 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
847 *len = i;
848 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
849 *len = i;
850 else if (i >= 2 && strncmp (encoded + i - 2, "___", 3) == 0)
851 *len = i - 2;
852 else if (i >= 1 && strncmp (encoded + i - 1, "__", 2) == 0)
853 *len = i - 1;
854 }
855 }
856
857 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
858 subprograms. */
859
860 static void
861 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
862 {
863 /* Remove trailing N. */
864
865 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
866 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
867 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
868 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
869 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
870 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
871 entity is internal. */
872
873 if (*len > 1
874 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
875 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
876 *len = *len - 1;
877 }
878
879 /* Remove trailing X[bn]* suffixes (indicating names in package bodies). */
880
881 static void
882 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
883 {
884 int i = *len - 1;
885
886 while (i > 0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'))
887 i--;
888
889 if (encoded[i] != 'X')
890 return;
891
892 if (i == 0)
893 return;
894
895 if (isalnum (encoded[i-1]))
896 *len = i;
897 }
898
899 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
900 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
901 replaced by ENCODED.
902
903 The resulting string is valid until the next call of ada_decode.
904 If the string is unchanged by decoding, the original string pointer
905 is returned. */
906
907 const char *
908 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
909 {
910 int i, j;
911 int len0;
912 const char *p;
913 char *decoded;
914 int at_start_name;
915 static char *decoding_buffer = NULL;
916 static size_t decoding_buffer_size = 0;
917
918 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
919 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
920 if we see this prefix. */
921 if (strncmp (encoded, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
922 encoded += 5;
923
924 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
925 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
926 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
927 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
928 goto Suppress;
929
930 len0 = strlen (encoded);
931
932 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
933 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
934
935 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
936 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
937 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
938 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
939 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
940 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
941 {
942 if (p[3] == 'X')
943 len0 = p - encoded;
944 else
945 goto Suppress;
946 }
947
948 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
949 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
950 appear in the decoded name. */
951
952 if (len0 > 3 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB", 3) == 0)
953 len0 -= 3;
954
955 /* Remove any trailing TB suffix. The TB suffix is slightly different
956 from the TKB suffix because it is used for non-anonymous task
957 bodies. */
958
959 if (len0 > 2 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 2, "TB", 2) == 0)
960 len0 -= 2;
961
962 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
963 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
964
965 if (len0 > 1 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 1, "B", 1) == 0)
966 len0 -= 1;
967
968 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
969
970 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, 2 * len0 + 1);
971 decoded = decoding_buffer;
972
973 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
974
975 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
976 {
977 i = len0 - 2;
978 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
979 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
980 i -= 1;
981 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
982 len0 = i - 1;
983 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
984 len0 = i;
985 }
986
987 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
988 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
989
990 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
991 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
992
993 at_start_name = 1;
994 while (i < len0)
995 {
996 /* Is this a symbol function? */
997 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
998 {
999 int k;
1000 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
1001 {
1002 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
1003 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
1004 op_len - 1) == 0)
1005 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
1006 {
1007 strcpy (decoded + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1008 at_start_name = 0;
1009 i += op_len;
1010 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1011 break;
1012 }
1013 }
1014 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
1015 continue;
1016 }
1017 at_start_name = 0;
1018
1019 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
1020 into "." (just below). */
1021
1022 if (i < len0 - 4 && strncmp (encoded + i, "TK__", 4) == 0)
1023 i += 2;
1024
1025 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
1026 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
1027 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
1028
1029 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
1030 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1031 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1032 {
1033 int k = i + 5;
1034
1035 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1036 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1037
1038 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1039 is indeed followed by "__". */
1040 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1041 i = k;
1042 }
1043
1044 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1045
1046 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1047 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1048 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1049 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1050 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1051 by a 'B'.
1052
1053 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1054 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1055 internally generated. */
1056
1057 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1058 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1059 {
1060 int k = i + 3;
1061
1062 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1063 k++;
1064
1065 if (k < len0
1066 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1067 {
1068 k++;
1069 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1070 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1071 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1072 if (k == len0
1073 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1074 i = k;
1075 }
1076 }
1077
1078 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1079 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1080
1081 if (i < len0 + 3
1082 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1083 {
1084 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1085 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1086 digits or lowercase characters. */
1087 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1088
1089 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1090 ptr--;
1091 if (ptr < encoded
1092 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1093 i++;
1094 }
1095
1096 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1097 {
1098 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1099 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1100 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1101 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1102 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1103 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1104 package names. */
1105 do
1106 i += 1;
1107 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1108 if (i < len0)
1109 goto Suppress;
1110 }
1111 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1112 {
1113 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1114 decoded[j] = '.';
1115 at_start_name = 1;
1116 i += 2;
1117 j += 1;
1118 }
1119 else
1120 {
1121 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1122 over. */
1123 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1124 i += 1;
1125 j += 1;
1126 }
1127 }
1128 decoded[j] = '\000';
1129
1130 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1131 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1132
1133 for (i = 0; decoded[i] != '\0'; i += 1)
1134 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1135 goto Suppress;
1136
1137 if (strcmp (decoded, encoded) == 0)
1138 return encoded;
1139 else
1140 return decoded;
1141
1142 Suppress:
1143 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, strlen (encoded) + 3);
1144 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1145 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1146 strcpy (decoded, encoded);
1147 else
1148 xsnprintf (decoded, decoding_buffer_size, "<%s>", encoded);
1149 return decoded;
1150
1151 }
1152
1153 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1154 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1155 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1156 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1157 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1158 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1159
1160 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1161 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1162 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1163 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1164 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1165 GSYMBOL).
1166 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1167 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1168 when a decoded name is cached in it.
1169 */
1170
1171 char *
1172 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol)
1173 {
1174 char **resultp =
1175 (char **) &gsymbol->language_specific.cplus_specific.demangled_name;
1176 if (*resultp == NULL)
1177 {
1178 const char *decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->name);
1179 if (gsymbol->obj_section != NULL)
1180 {
1181 struct objfile *objf = gsymbol->obj_section->objfile;
1182 *resultp = obsavestring (decoded, strlen (decoded),
1183 &objf->objfile_obstack);
1184 }
1185 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in which
1186 case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only decode
1187 when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1188 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1189 if (*resultp == NULL)
1190 {
1191 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1192 decoded, INSERT);
1193 if (*slot == NULL)
1194 *slot = xstrdup (decoded);
1195 *resultp = *slot;
1196 }
1197 }
1198
1199 return *resultp;
1200 }
1201
1202 static char *
1203 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1204 {
1205 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded));
1206 }
1207
1208 /* Returns non-zero iff SYM_NAME matches NAME, ignoring any trailing
1209 suffixes that encode debugging information or leading _ada_ on
1210 SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
1211 information that is ignored). If WILD, then NAME need only match a
1212 suffix of SYM_NAME minus the same suffixes. Also returns 0 if
1213 either argument is NULL. */
1214
1215 static int
1216 ada_match_name (const char *sym_name, const char *name, int wild)
1217 {
1218 if (sym_name == NULL || name == NULL)
1219 return 0;
1220 else if (wild)
1221 return wild_match (name, strlen (name), sym_name);
1222 else
1223 {
1224 int len_name = strlen (name);
1225 return (strncmp (sym_name, name, len_name) == 0
1226 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name))
1227 || (strncmp (sym_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0
1228 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, name, len_name) == 0
1229 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name + 5));
1230 }
1231 }
1232 \f
1233
1234 /* Arrays */
1235
1236 /* Names of MAX_ADA_DIMENS bounds in P_BOUNDS fields of array descriptors. */
1237
1238 static char *bound_name[] = {
1239 "LB0", "UB0", "LB1", "UB1", "LB2", "UB2", "LB3", "UB3",
1240 "LB4", "UB4", "LB5", "UB5", "LB6", "UB6", "LB7", "UB7"
1241 };
1242
1243 /* Maximum number of array dimensions we are prepared to handle. */
1244
1245 #define MAX_ADA_DIMENS (sizeof(bound_name) / (2*sizeof(char *)))
1246
1247 /* Like modify_field, but allows bitpos > wordlength. */
1248
1249 static void
1250 modify_general_field (struct type *type, char *addr,
1251 LONGEST fieldval, int bitpos, int bitsize)
1252 {
1253 modify_field (type, addr + bitpos / 8, fieldval, bitpos % 8, bitsize);
1254 }
1255
1256
1257 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1258 (fat pointers). */
1259
1260 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1261 level of indirection, if needed. */
1262
1263 static struct type *
1264 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1265 {
1266 if (type == NULL)
1267 return NULL;
1268 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1269 if (type != NULL
1270 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1271 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1272 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1273 else
1274 return type;
1275 }
1276
1277 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1278
1279 static int
1280 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1281 {
1282 return
1283 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1284 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1285 }
1286
1287 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1288
1289 static struct type *
1290 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1291 {
1292 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1293 if (base_type == NULL)
1294 return NULL;
1295 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1296 return base_type;
1297 else
1298 {
1299 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1300 if (alt_type == NULL)
1301 return base_type;
1302 else
1303 return alt_type;
1304 }
1305 }
1306
1307 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1308
1309 static struct value *
1310 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1311 {
1312 struct type *type = value_type (val);
1313 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1314 data_type = lookup_pointer_type (data_type);
1315
1316 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1317 return value_cast (data_type, value_copy (val));
1318 else
1319 return value_from_longest (data_type, value_address (val));
1320 }
1321
1322 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1323
1324 static int
1325 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1326 {
1327 type = desc_base_type (type);
1328 return (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1329 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1330 }
1331
1332 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1333 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1334
1335 static struct type *
1336 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1337 {
1338 struct type *r;
1339
1340 type = desc_base_type (type);
1341
1342 if (type == NULL)
1343 return NULL;
1344 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1345 {
1346 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1347 if (type == NULL)
1348 return NULL;
1349 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1350 if (r != NULL)
1351 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1352 }
1353 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1354 {
1355 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1356 if (r != NULL)
1357 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1358 }
1359 return NULL;
1360 }
1361
1362 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1363 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1364
1365 static struct value *
1366 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1367 {
1368 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1369 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1370 {
1371 struct type *bounds_type =
1372 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1373 LONGEST addr;
1374
1375 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1376 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1377
1378 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1379 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1380 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1381 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1382 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1383 else
1384 addr = value_address (arr);
1385
1386 return
1387 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1388 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1389 }
1390
1391 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1392 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1393 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1394 else
1395 return NULL;
1396 }
1397
1398 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1399 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1400
1401 static int
1402 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1403 {
1404 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1405 }
1406
1407 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1408 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1409
1410 static int
1411 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1412 {
1413 type = desc_base_type (type);
1414
1415 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1416 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1417 else
1418 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1419 }
1420
1421 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1422 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a array-with-no-bounds type);
1423 otherwise, NULL. Use ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds
1424 data. */
1425
1426 static struct type *
1427 desc_data_target_type (struct type *type)
1428 {
1429 type = desc_base_type (type);
1430
1431 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1432 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1433 return desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1));
1434 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1435 {
1436 struct type *data_type = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1437
1438 if (data_type
1439 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (data_type)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1440 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type);
1441 }
1442
1443 return NULL;
1444 }
1445
1446 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1447 its array data. */
1448
1449 static struct value *
1450 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1451 {
1452 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1453 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1454 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1455 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1456 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1457 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1458 else
1459 return NULL;
1460 }
1461
1462
1463 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1464 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1465
1466 static int
1467 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1468 {
1469 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1470 }
1471
1472 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1473 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1474
1475 static int
1476 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1477 {
1478 type = desc_base_type (type);
1479
1480 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1481 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1482 else
1483 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1484 }
1485
1486 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1487 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1488 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1489
1490 static struct value *
1491 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1492 {
1493 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name[2 * i + which - 2], NULL,
1494 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1495 }
1496
1497 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1498 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1499 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1500
1501 static int
1502 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1503 {
1504 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1505 }
1506
1507 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1508 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1509 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1510
1511 static int
1512 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1513 {
1514 type = desc_base_type (type);
1515
1516 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1517 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1518 else
1519 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1520 }
1521
1522 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1523 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1524
1525 static struct type *
1526 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1527 {
1528 type = desc_base_type (type);
1529
1530 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1531 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name[2 * i - 2], 1);
1532 else
1533 return NULL;
1534 }
1535
1536 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1537 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1538
1539 static int
1540 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1541 {
1542 type = desc_base_type (type);
1543
1544 if (type != NULL)
1545 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2;
1546 return 0;
1547 }
1548
1549 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1550 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1551 type). */
1552
1553 static int
1554 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1555 {
1556 if (type == NULL)
1557 return 0;
1558 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1559 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1560 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1561 }
1562
1563 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1564 * to one. */
1565
1566 static int
1567 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1568 {
1569 while (type != NULL
1570 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1571 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1572 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1573 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1574 }
1575
1576 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1577
1578 int
1579 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1580 {
1581 if (type == NULL)
1582 return 0;
1583 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1584 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1585 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1586 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY));
1587 }
1588
1589 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1590
1591 int
1592 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1593 {
1594 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
1595
1596 if (type == NULL)
1597 return 0;
1598 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1599 return (data_type != NULL
1600 && TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1601 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0);
1602 }
1603
1604 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1605 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1606 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1607 is still needed. */
1608
1609 int
1610 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1611 {
1612 return
1613 type != NULL
1614 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1615 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1616 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1617 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1618 }
1619
1620
1621 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1622 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1623 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1624 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1625 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1626 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1627 a descriptor. */
1628 struct type *
1629 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1630 {
1631 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1632 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1633
1634 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1635 return value_type (arr);
1636
1637 if (!bounds)
1638 {
1639 struct type *array_type =
1640 ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (value_type (arr)));
1641
1642 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1643 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (array_type, 0) =
1644 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1645
1646 return array_type;
1647 }
1648 else
1649 {
1650 struct type *elt_type;
1651 int arity;
1652 struct value *descriptor;
1653
1654 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1655 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1656
1657 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1658 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1659
1660 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1661 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1662 return NULL;
1663 while (arity > 0)
1664 {
1665 struct type *range_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1666 struct type *array_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1667 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1668 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1669 arity -= 1;
1670
1671 create_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1672 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1673 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1674 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1675
1676 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1677 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) =
1678 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1679 }
1680
1681 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
1682 }
1683 }
1684
1685 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1686 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
1687 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
1688 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
1689
1690 struct value *
1691 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
1692 {
1693 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1694 {
1695 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
1696 if (arrType == NULL)
1697 return NULL;
1698 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
1699 }
1700 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1701 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1702 else
1703 return arr;
1704 }
1705
1706 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1707 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
1708 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
1709
1710 static struct value *
1711 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
1712 {
1713 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1714 {
1715 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
1716 if (arrVal == NULL)
1717 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
1718 check_size (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
1719 return value_ind (arrVal);
1720 }
1721 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1722 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1723 else
1724 return arr;
1725 }
1726
1727 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
1728 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
1729 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
1730
1731 struct type *
1732 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1733 {
1734 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
1735 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type);
1736
1737 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
1738 return ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (type));
1739
1740 return type;
1741 }
1742
1743 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
1744
1745 static int
1746 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1747 {
1748 if (type == NULL)
1749 return 0;
1750 type = desc_base_type (type);
1751 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1752 return
1753 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
1754 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
1755 }
1756
1757 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT constrained
1758 packed-array type. */
1759
1760 int
1761 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1762 {
1763 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
1764 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1765 }
1766
1767 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents an array descriptor for a
1768 unconstrained packed-array type. */
1769
1770 static int
1771 ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1772 {
1773 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
1774 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1775 }
1776
1777 /* Given that TYPE encodes a packed array type (constrained or unconstrained),
1778 return the size of its elements in bits. */
1779
1780 static long
1781 decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *type)
1782 {
1783 char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
1784 char *tail;
1785 long bits;
1786
1787 if (!raw_name)
1788 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
1789
1790 if (!raw_name)
1791 return 0;
1792
1793 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
1794
1795 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
1796 {
1797 lim_warning
1798 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
1799 return 0;
1800 }
1801
1802 return bits;
1803 }
1804
1805 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
1806 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
1807 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
1808 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
1809 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
1810 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
1811 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
1812 in bits. */
1813
1814 static struct type *
1815 constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
1816 {
1817 struct type *new_elt_type;
1818 struct type *new_type;
1819 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
1820
1821 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1822 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1823 return type;
1824
1825 new_type = alloc_type_copy (type);
1826 new_elt_type =
1827 constrained_packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
1828 elt_bits);
1829 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
1830 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
1831 TYPE_NAME (new_type) = ada_type_name (type);
1832
1833 if (get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type),
1834 &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
1835 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
1836 if (high_bound < low_bound)
1837 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
1838 else
1839 {
1840 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
1841 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
1842 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1843 }
1844
1845 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1;
1846 return new_type;
1847 }
1848
1849 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where
1850 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
1851
1852 static struct type *
1853 decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1854 {
1855 struct symbol *sym;
1856 struct block **blocks;
1857 char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
1858 char *name;
1859 char *tail;
1860 struct type *shadow_type;
1861 long bits;
1862 int i, n;
1863
1864 if (!raw_name)
1865 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
1866
1867 if (!raw_name)
1868 return NULL;
1869
1870 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
1871 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
1872 type = desc_base_type (type);
1873
1874 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
1875 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
1876
1877 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN);
1878 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_TYPE (sym) == NULL)
1879 {
1880 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
1881 return NULL;
1882 }
1883 shadow_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
1884 CHECK_TYPEDEF (shadow_type);
1885
1886 if (TYPE_CODE (shadow_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1887 {
1888 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds information on packed array"));
1889 return NULL;
1890 }
1891
1892 bits = decode_packed_array_bitsize (type);
1893 return constrained_packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
1894 }
1895
1896 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT constrained packed
1897 array, returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
1898 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
1899 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
1900 type length is set appropriately. */
1901
1902 static struct value *
1903 decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *arr)
1904 {
1905 struct type *type;
1906
1907 arr = ada_coerce_ref (arr);
1908
1909 /* If our value is a pointer, then dererence it. Make sure that
1910 this operation does not cause the target type to be fixed, as
1911 this would indirectly cause this array to be decoded. The rest
1912 of the routine assumes that the array hasn't been decoded yet,
1913 so we use the basic "value_ind" routine to perform the dereferencing,
1914 as opposed to using "ada_value_ind". */
1915 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arr)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1916 arr = value_ind (arr);
1917
1918 type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1919 if (type == NULL)
1920 {
1921 error (_("can't unpack array"));
1922 return NULL;
1923 }
1924
1925 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (arr)))
1926 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
1927 {
1928 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
1929 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
1930 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
1931 first left-justify it. */
1932 int bit_size, bit_pos;
1933 ULONGEST mod;
1934
1935 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
1936 bit_size = 0;
1937 while (mod > 0)
1938 {
1939 bit_size += 1;
1940 mod >>= 1;
1941 }
1942 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
1943 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
1944 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
1945 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
1946 bit_size,
1947 type);
1948 }
1949
1950 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
1951 }
1952
1953
1954 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
1955 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
1956
1957 static struct value *
1958 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
1959 {
1960 int i;
1961 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
1962 long elt_total_bit_offset;
1963 struct type *elt_type;
1964 struct value *v;
1965
1966 bits = 0;
1967 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
1968 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1969 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
1970 {
1971 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1972 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
1973 error
1974 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of something other than a packed array"));
1975 else
1976 {
1977 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
1978 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
1979 LONGEST idx;
1980
1981 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
1982 {
1983 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
1984 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
1985 }
1986
1987 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]);
1988 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
1989 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"), (long) idx);
1990 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
1991 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
1992 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
1993 }
1994 }
1995 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1996 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1997
1998 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
1999 bits, elt_type);
2000 return v;
2001 }
2002
2003 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
2004
2005 static int
2006 has_negatives (struct type *type)
2007 {
2008 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2009 {
2010 default:
2011 return 0;
2012 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
2013 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
2014 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2015 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) < 0;
2016 }
2017 }
2018
2019
2020 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
2021 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
2022 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
2023 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
2024 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
2025 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
2026 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
2027 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
2028
2029 struct value *
2030 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
2031 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2032 struct type *type)
2033 {
2034 struct value *v;
2035 int src, /* Index into the source area */
2036 targ, /* Index into the target area */
2037 srcBitsLeft, /* Number of source bits left to move */
2038 nsrc, ntarg, /* Number of source and target bytes */
2039 unusedLS, /* Number of bits in next significant
2040 byte of source that are unused */
2041 accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
2042 unsigned char *bytes; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
2043 unsigned char *unpacked;
2044 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
2045 unsigned char sign;
2046 int len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2047 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
2048 the indices move. */
2049 int delta = gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)) ? -1 : 1;
2050
2051 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2052
2053 if (obj == NULL)
2054 {
2055 v = allocate_value (type);
2056 bytes = (unsigned char *) (valaddr + offset);
2057 }
2058 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
2059 {
2060 v = value_at (type,
2061 value_address (obj) + offset);
2062 bytes = (unsigned char *) alloca (len);
2063 read_memory (value_address (v), bytes, len);
2064 }
2065 else
2066 {
2067 v = allocate_value (type);
2068 bytes = (unsigned char *) value_contents (obj) + offset;
2069 }
2070
2071 if (obj != NULL)
2072 {
2073 CORE_ADDR new_addr;
2074 set_value_component_location (v, obj);
2075 new_addr = value_address (obj) + offset;
2076 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
2077 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2078 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2079 {
2080 ++new_addr;
2081 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2082 }
2083 set_value_address (v, new_addr);
2084 }
2085 else
2086 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2087 unpacked = (unsigned char *) value_contents (v);
2088
2089 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
2090 nsrc = len;
2091 ntarg = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
2092 sign = 0;
2093 if (bit_size == 0)
2094 {
2095 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2096 return v;
2097 }
2098 else if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2099 {
2100 src = len - 1;
2101 if (has_negatives (type)
2102 && ((bytes[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2103 sign = ~0;
2104
2105 unusedLS =
2106 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2107 % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2108
2109 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2110 {
2111 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
2112 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
2113 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
2114 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2115 accumSize =
2116 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2117 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2118 of the target. */
2119 targ = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2120 ntarg = targ + 1;
2121 break;
2122 default:
2123 accumSize = 0;
2124 targ = TYPE_LENGTH (type) - 1;
2125 break;
2126 }
2127 }
2128 else
2129 {
2130 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2131
2132 src = targ = 0;
2133 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2134 accumSize = 0;
2135
2136 if (has_negatives (type) && (bytes[len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2137 sign = ~0;
2138 }
2139
2140 accum = 0;
2141 while (nsrc > 0)
2142 {
2143 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2144 part of the value. */
2145 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2146 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2147 1;
2148 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2149 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2150 accum |=
2151 (((bytes[src] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2152 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2153 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2154 {
2155 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2156 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2157 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2158 ntarg -= 1;
2159 targ += delta;
2160 }
2161 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2162 unusedLS = 0;
2163 nsrc -= 1;
2164 src += delta;
2165 }
2166 while (ntarg > 0)
2167 {
2168 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2169 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2170 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2171 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2172 ntarg -= 1;
2173 targ += delta;
2174 }
2175
2176 return v;
2177 }
2178
2179 /* Move N bits from SOURCE, starting at bit offset SRC_OFFSET to
2180 TARGET, starting at bit offset TARG_OFFSET. SOURCE and TARGET must
2181 not overlap. */
2182 static void
2183 move_bits (gdb_byte *target, int targ_offset, const gdb_byte *source,
2184 int src_offset, int n, int bits_big_endian_p)
2185 {
2186 unsigned int accum, mask;
2187 int accum_bits, chunk_size;
2188
2189 target += targ_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2190 targ_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2191 source += src_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2192 src_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2193 if (bits_big_endian_p)
2194 {
2195 accum = (unsigned char) *source;
2196 source += 1;
2197 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2198
2199 while (n > 0)
2200 {
2201 int unused_right;
2202 accum = (accum << HOST_CHAR_BIT) + (unsigned char) *source;
2203 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2204 source += 1;
2205 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2206 if (chunk_size > n)
2207 chunk_size = n;
2208 unused_right = HOST_CHAR_BIT - (chunk_size + targ_offset);
2209 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << unused_right;
2210 *target =
2211 (*target & ~mask)
2212 | ((accum >> (accum_bits - chunk_size - unused_right)) & mask);
2213 n -= chunk_size;
2214 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2215 target += 1;
2216 targ_offset = 0;
2217 }
2218 }
2219 else
2220 {
2221 accum = (unsigned char) *source >> src_offset;
2222 source += 1;
2223 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2224
2225 while (n > 0)
2226 {
2227 accum = accum + ((unsigned char) *source << accum_bits);
2228 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2229 source += 1;
2230 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2231 if (chunk_size > n)
2232 chunk_size = n;
2233 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << targ_offset;
2234 *target = (*target & ~mask) | ((accum << targ_offset) & mask);
2235 n -= chunk_size;
2236 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2237 accum >>= chunk_size;
2238 target += 1;
2239 targ_offset = 0;
2240 }
2241 }
2242 }
2243
2244 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2245 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2246 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2247 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2248
2249 static struct value *
2250 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2251 {
2252 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2253 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2254
2255 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2256 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2257
2258 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2259 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2260 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2261 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2262
2263 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2264 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2265
2266 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2267 && bits > 0
2268 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2269 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2270 {
2271 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2272 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2273 int from_size;
2274 char *buffer = (char *) alloca (len);
2275 struct value *val;
2276 CORE_ADDR to_addr = value_address (toval);
2277
2278 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2279 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2280
2281 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2282 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval);
2283 if (from_size == 0)
2284 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
2285 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2286 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2287 value_contents (fromval), from_size - bits, bits, 1);
2288 else
2289 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2290 value_contents (fromval), 0, bits, 0);
2291 write_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2292 if (deprecated_memory_changed_hook)
2293 deprecated_memory_changed_hook (to_addr, len);
2294
2295 val = value_copy (toval);
2296 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2297 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2298 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2299
2300 return val;
2301 }
2302
2303 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2304 }
2305
2306
2307 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2308 * CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2309 * CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2310 * COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2311 * of COMPONENT are ignored. */
2312 static void
2313 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2314 struct value *val)
2315 {
2316 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2317 (LONGEST) (value_address (component) - value_address (container));
2318 int bit_offset_in_container =
2319 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2320 int bits;
2321
2322 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2323
2324 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2325 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2326 else
2327 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2328
2329 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (container))))
2330 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2331 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2332 value_contents (val),
2333 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits,
2334 bits, 1);
2335 else
2336 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2337 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2338 value_contents (val), 0, bits, 0);
2339 }
2340
2341 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2342 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2343 thereto. */
2344
2345 struct value *
2346 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2347 {
2348 int k;
2349 struct value *elt;
2350 struct type *elt_type;
2351
2352 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2353
2354 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2355 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2356 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2357 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2358
2359 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2360 {
2361 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2362 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2363 elt = value_subscript (elt, pos_atr (ind[k]));
2364 }
2365 return elt;
2366 }
2367
2368 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a standard GDB array of type TYPE, the
2369 value of the element of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in
2370 IND. Does not read the entire array into memory. */
2371
2372 static struct value *
2373 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, struct type *type, int arity,
2374 struct value **ind)
2375 {
2376 int k;
2377
2378 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2379 {
2380 LONGEST lwb, upb;
2381
2382 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2383 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2384 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2385 value_copy (arr));
2386 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2387 arr = value_ptradd (arr, pos_atr (ind[k]) - lwb);
2388 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2389 }
2390
2391 return value_ind (arr);
2392 }
2393
2394 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2395 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of HIGH-LOW+1
2396 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of this array is LOW, as
2397 per Ada rules. */
2398 static struct value *
2399 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2400 int low, int high)
2401 {
2402 CORE_ADDR base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2403 + ((low - TYPE_LOW_BOUND (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type)))
2404 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
2405 struct type *index_type =
2406 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type)),
2407 low, high);
2408 struct type *slice_type =
2409 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2410 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base);
2411 }
2412
2413
2414 static struct value *
2415 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2416 {
2417 struct type *type = value_type (array);
2418 struct type *index_type =
2419 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2420 struct type *slice_type =
2421 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2422 return value_cast (slice_type, value_slice (array, low, high - low + 1));
2423 }
2424
2425 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2426 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2427 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2428 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2429
2430 int
2431 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2432 {
2433 int arity;
2434
2435 if (type == NULL)
2436 return 0;
2437
2438 type = desc_base_type (type);
2439
2440 arity = 0;
2441 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2442 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2443 else
2444 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2445 {
2446 arity += 1;
2447 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2448 }
2449
2450 return arity;
2451 }
2452
2453 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2454 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2455 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2456 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2457
2458 struct type *
2459 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2460 {
2461 type = desc_base_type (type);
2462
2463 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2464 {
2465 int k;
2466 struct type *p_array_type;
2467
2468 p_array_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
2469
2470 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2471 if (k == 0)
2472 return NULL;
2473
2474 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2475 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2476 k = nindices;
2477 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2478 {
2479 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2480 k -= 1;
2481 }
2482 return p_array_type;
2483 }
2484 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2485 {
2486 while (nindices != 0 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2487 {
2488 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2489 nindices -= 1;
2490 }
2491 return type;
2492 }
2493
2494 return NULL;
2495 }
2496
2497 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2498 Does not examine memory. Throws an error if N is invalid or TYPE
2499 is not an array type. NAME is the name of the Ada attribute being
2500 evaluated ('range, 'first, 'last, or 'length); it is used in building
2501 the error message. */
2502
2503 static struct type *
2504 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n, const char *name)
2505 {
2506 struct type *result_type;
2507
2508 type = desc_base_type (type);
2509
2510 if (n < 0 || n > ada_array_arity (type))
2511 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"), name);
2512
2513 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2514 {
2515 int i;
2516
2517 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2518 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2519 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2520 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2521 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2522 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2523 if (result_type && TYPE_CODE (result_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2524 result_type = NULL;
2525 }
2526 else
2527 {
2528 result_type = desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2529 if (result_type == NULL)
2530 error (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
2531 }
2532
2533 return result_type;
2534 }
2535
2536 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2537 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2538 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2539 array-descriptor type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied
2540 by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2541
2542 static LONGEST
2543 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type * arr_type, int n, int which)
2544 {
2545 struct type *type, *elt_type, *index_type_desc, *index_type;
2546 LONGEST retval;
2547 int i;
2548
2549 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1);
2550
2551 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2552 arr_type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2553
2554 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2555 return (LONGEST) - which;
2556
2557 if (TYPE_CODE (arr_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2558 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2559 else
2560 type = arr_type;
2561
2562 elt_type = type;
2563 for (i = n; i > 1; i--)
2564 elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2565
2566 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2567 if (index_type_desc != NULL)
2568 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_type_desc, n - 1),
2569 NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type));
2570 else
2571 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2572
2573 switch (TYPE_CODE (index_type))
2574 {
2575 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2576 retval = which == 0 ? TYPE_LOW_BOUND (index_type)
2577 : TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (index_type);
2578 break;
2579 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
2580 retval = which == 0 ? TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (index_type, 0)
2581 : TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (index_type,
2582 TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type) - 1);
2583 break;
2584 default:
2585 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("invalid type code of index type"));
2586 }
2587
2588 return retval;
2589 }
2590
2591 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
2592 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2593 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2594 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2595
2596 static LONGEST
2597 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
2598 {
2599 struct type *arr_type = value_type (arr);
2600
2601 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2602 return ada_array_bound (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n, which);
2603 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2604 return ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which);
2605 else
2606 return value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which));
2607 }
2608
2609 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
2610 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2611 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
2612 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
2613 clauses at the moment. */
2614
2615 static LONGEST
2616 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
2617 {
2618 struct type *arr_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2619
2620 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2621 return ada_array_length (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n);
2622
2623 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2624 return (ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1)
2625 - ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0) + 1);
2626 else
2627 return (value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 1))
2628 - value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 0)) + 1);
2629 }
2630
2631 /* An empty array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type),
2632 with bounds LOW to LOW-1. */
2633
2634 static struct value *
2635 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low)
2636 {
2637 struct type *index_type =
2638 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type)),
2639 low, low - 1);
2640 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type, 1);
2641 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
2642 }
2643 \f
2644
2645 /* Name resolution */
2646
2647 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
2648 to OP. */
2649
2650 static const char *
2651 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
2652 {
2653 int i;
2654
2655 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
2656 {
2657 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
2658 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
2659 }
2660 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
2661 }
2662
2663
2664 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
2665 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
2666 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
2667 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
2668 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
2669 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
2670 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
2671 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
2672
2673 static void
2674 resolve (struct expression **expp, int void_context_p)
2675 {
2676 struct type *context_type = NULL;
2677 int pc = 0;
2678
2679 if (void_context_p)
2680 context_type = builtin_type ((*expp)->gdbarch)->builtin_void;
2681
2682 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, context_type);
2683 }
2684
2685 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
2686 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
2687 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
2688 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
2689 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
2690 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
2691 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
2692 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
2693
2694 static struct value *
2695 resolve_subexp (struct expression **expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
2696 struct type *context_type)
2697 {
2698 int pc = *pos;
2699 int i;
2700 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
2701 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
2702 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
2703 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
2704 int oplen;
2705
2706 argvec = NULL;
2707 nargs = 0;
2708 exp = *expp;
2709
2710 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
2711 if needed. */
2712 switch (op)
2713 {
2714 case OP_FUNCALL:
2715 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2716 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2717 *pos += 7;
2718 else
2719 {
2720 *pos += 3;
2721 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2722 }
2723 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
2724 break;
2725
2726 case UNOP_ADDR:
2727 *pos += 1;
2728 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2729 break;
2730
2731 case UNOP_QUAL:
2732 *pos += 3;
2733 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type));
2734 break;
2735
2736 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
2737 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
2738 case OP_ATR_TAG:
2739 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
2740 case OP_ATR_LAST:
2741 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
2742 case OP_ATR_POS:
2743 case OP_ATR_VAL:
2744 case OP_ATR_MIN:
2745 case OP_ATR_MAX:
2746 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
2747 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
2748 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
2749 case OP_AGGREGATE:
2750 case OP_OTHERS:
2751 case OP_CHOICES:
2752 case OP_POSITIONAL:
2753 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
2754 case OP_NAME:
2755 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
2756 *pos += oplen;
2757 break;
2758
2759 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
2760 {
2761 struct value *arg1;
2762
2763 *pos += 1;
2764 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2765 if (arg1 == NULL)
2766 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
2767 else
2768 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1));
2769 break;
2770 }
2771
2772 case UNOP_CAST:
2773 *pos += 3;
2774 nargs = 1;
2775 break;
2776
2777 case BINOP_ADD:
2778 case BINOP_SUB:
2779 case BINOP_MUL:
2780 case BINOP_DIV:
2781 case BINOP_REM:
2782 case BINOP_MOD:
2783 case BINOP_EXP:
2784 case BINOP_CONCAT:
2785 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
2786 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
2787 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
2788 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
2789 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
2790
2791 case BINOP_EQUAL:
2792 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
2793 case BINOP_LESS:
2794 case BINOP_GTR:
2795 case BINOP_LEQ:
2796 case BINOP_GEQ:
2797
2798 case BINOP_REPEAT:
2799 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
2800 case BINOP_COMMA:
2801 *pos += 1;
2802 nargs = 2;
2803 break;
2804
2805 case UNOP_NEG:
2806 case UNOP_PLUS:
2807 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
2808 case UNOP_ABS:
2809 case UNOP_IND:
2810 *pos += 1;
2811 nargs = 1;
2812 break;
2813
2814 case OP_LONG:
2815 case OP_DOUBLE:
2816 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
2817 *pos += 4;
2818 break;
2819
2820 case OP_TYPE:
2821 case OP_BOOL:
2822 case OP_LAST:
2823 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
2824 *pos += 3;
2825 break;
2826
2827 case UNOP_MEMVAL:
2828 *pos += 3;
2829 nargs = 1;
2830 break;
2831
2832 case OP_REGISTER:
2833 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
2834 break;
2835
2836 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
2837 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
2838 nargs = 1;
2839 break;
2840
2841 case TERNOP_SLICE:
2842 *pos += 1;
2843 nargs = 3;
2844 break;
2845
2846 case OP_STRING:
2847 break;
2848
2849 default:
2850 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
2851 }
2852
2853 argvec = (struct value * *) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 1));
2854 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
2855 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
2856 argvec[i] = NULL;
2857 exp = *expp;
2858
2859 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
2860 switch (op)
2861 {
2862 default:
2863 break;
2864
2865 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
2866 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2867 {
2868 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
2869 int n_candidates;
2870
2871 n_candidates =
2872 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
2873 (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
2874 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
2875 &candidates);
2876
2877 if (n_candidates > 1)
2878 {
2879 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
2880 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
2881 out all types. */
2882 int j;
2883 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
2884 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym))
2885 {
2886 case LOC_REGISTER:
2887 case LOC_ARG:
2888 case LOC_REF_ARG:
2889 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
2890 case LOC_LOCAL:
2891 case LOC_COMPUTED:
2892 goto FoundNonType;
2893 default:
2894 break;
2895 }
2896 FoundNonType:
2897 if (j < n_candidates)
2898 {
2899 j = 0;
2900 while (j < n_candidates)
2901 {
2902 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
2903 {
2904 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
2905 n_candidates -= 1;
2906 }
2907 else
2908 j += 1;
2909 }
2910 }
2911 }
2912
2913 if (n_candidates == 0)
2914 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
2915 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2916 else if (n_candidates == 1)
2917 i = 0;
2918 else if (deprocedure_p
2919 && !is_nonfunction (candidates, n_candidates))
2920 {
2921 i = ada_resolve_function
2922 (candidates, n_candidates, NULL, 0,
2923 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
2924 context_type);
2925 if (i < 0)
2926 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
2927 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2928 }
2929 else
2930 {
2931 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
2932 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2933 user_select_syms (candidates, n_candidates, 1);
2934 i = 0;
2935 }
2936
2937 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
2938 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
2939 if (innermost_block == NULL
2940 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
2941 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
2942 }
2943
2944 if (deprocedure_p
2945 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))
2946 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC))
2947 {
2948 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 0,
2949 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
2950 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
2951 exp = *expp;
2952 }
2953 break;
2954
2955 case OP_FUNCALL:
2956 {
2957 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2958 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2959 {
2960 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
2961 int n_candidates;
2962
2963 n_candidates =
2964 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
2965 (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
2966 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
2967 &candidates);
2968 if (n_candidates == 1)
2969 i = 0;
2970 else
2971 {
2972 i = ada_resolve_function
2973 (candidates, n_candidates,
2974 argvec, nargs,
2975 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
2976 context_type);
2977 if (i < 0)
2978 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
2979 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
2980 }
2981
2982 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
2983 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
2984 if (innermost_block == NULL
2985 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
2986 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
2987 }
2988 }
2989 break;
2990 case BINOP_ADD:
2991 case BINOP_SUB:
2992 case BINOP_MUL:
2993 case BINOP_DIV:
2994 case BINOP_REM:
2995 case BINOP_MOD:
2996 case BINOP_CONCAT:
2997 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
2998 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
2999 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3000 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3001 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3002 case BINOP_LESS:
3003 case BINOP_GTR:
3004 case BINOP_LEQ:
3005 case BINOP_GEQ:
3006 case BINOP_EXP:
3007 case UNOP_NEG:
3008 case UNOP_PLUS:
3009 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3010 case UNOP_ABS:
3011 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
3012 {
3013 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3014 int n_candidates;
3015
3016 n_candidates =
3017 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_encode (ada_decoded_op_name (op)),
3018 (struct block *) NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
3019 &candidates);
3020 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates, n_candidates, argvec, nargs,
3021 ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL);
3022 if (i < 0)
3023 break;
3024
3025 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
3026 candidates[i].sym, candidates[i].block);
3027 exp = *expp;
3028 }
3029 break;
3030
3031 case OP_TYPE:
3032 case OP_REGISTER:
3033 return NULL;
3034 }
3035
3036 *pos = pc;
3037 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
3038 }
3039
3040 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
3041 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
3042 a non-pointer. */
3043 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
3044 liberal. */
3045
3046 static int
3047 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
3048 {
3049 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
3050 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
3051
3052 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3053 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
3054 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3055 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
3056
3057 switch (TYPE_CODE (ftype))
3058 {
3059 default:
3060 return TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE (atype);
3061 case TYPE_CODE_PTR:
3062 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3063 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
3064 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
3065 else
3066 return (may_deref
3067 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
3068 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3069 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3070 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3071 switch (TYPE_CODE (atype))
3072 {
3073 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3074 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3075 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3076 return 1;
3077 default:
3078 return 0;
3079 }
3080
3081 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3082 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3083 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3084
3085 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3086 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3087 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3088 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3089 else
3090 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3091 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3092
3093 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3094 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3095 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE (ftype));
3096 }
3097 }
3098
3099 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3100 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3101 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3102 argument function. */
3103
3104 static int
3105 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3106 {
3107 int i;
3108 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3109
3110 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3111 && TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3112 return (n_actuals == 0);
3113 else if (func_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (func_type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3114 return 0;
3115
3116 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals)
3117 return 0;
3118
3119 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3120 {
3121 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3122 return 0;
3123 else
3124 {
3125 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type, i));
3126 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3127
3128 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3129 return 0;
3130 }
3131 }
3132 return 1;
3133 }
3134
3135 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3136 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3137 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3138 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3139
3140 static int
3141 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3142 {
3143 struct type *return_type;
3144
3145 if (func_type == NULL)
3146 return 1;
3147
3148 if (TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3149 return_type = base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3150 else
3151 return_type = base_type (func_type);
3152 if (return_type == NULL)
3153 return 1;
3154
3155 context_type = base_type (context_type);
3156
3157 if (TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3158 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3159 else if (context_type == NULL)
3160 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3161 else
3162 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE (context_type);
3163 }
3164
3165
3166 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3167 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3168 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3169 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3170 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3171 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3172
3173 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3174 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3175 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3176 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3177
3178 static int
3179 ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info syms[],
3180 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3181 const char *name, struct type *context_type)
3182 {
3183 int fallback;
3184 int k;
3185 int m; /* Number of hits */
3186
3187 m = 0;
3188 /* In the first pass of the loop, we only accept functions matching
3189 context_type. If none are found, we add a second pass of the loop
3190 where every function is accepted. */
3191 for (fallback = 0; m == 0 && fallback < 2; fallback++)
3192 {
3193 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3194 {
3195 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].sym));
3196
3197 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].sym, args, nargs)
3198 && (fallback || return_match (type, context_type)))
3199 {
3200 syms[m] = syms[k];
3201 m += 1;
3202 }
3203 }
3204 }
3205
3206 if (m == 0)
3207 return -1;
3208 else if (m > 1)
3209 {
3210 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
3211 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
3212 return 0;
3213 }
3214 return 0;
3215 }
3216
3217 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3218 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3219 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3220 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3221 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3222
3223 static int
3224 encoded_ordered_before (char *N0, char *N1)
3225 {
3226 if (N1 == NULL)
3227 return 0;
3228 else if (N0 == NULL)
3229 return 1;
3230 else
3231 {
3232 int k0, k1;
3233 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3234 ;
3235 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3236 ;
3237 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3238 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3239 {
3240 int n0, n1;
3241 n0 = k0;
3242 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3243 n0 -= 1;
3244 n1 = k1;
3245 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3246 n1 -= 1;
3247 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3248 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3249 }
3250 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3251 }
3252 }
3253
3254 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3255 encoded names. */
3256
3257 static void
3258 sort_choices (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int nsyms)
3259 {
3260 int i;
3261 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3262 {
3263 struct ada_symbol_info sym = syms[i];
3264 int j;
3265
3266 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3267 {
3268 if (encoded_ordered_before (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
3269 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym.sym)))
3270 break;
3271 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3272 }
3273 syms[j + 1] = sym;
3274 }
3275 }
3276
3277 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3278 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3279 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3280 selected. */
3281
3282 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3283 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3284
3285 int
3286 user_select_syms (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3287 {
3288 int i;
3289 int *chosen = (int *) alloca (sizeof (int) * nsyms);
3290 int n_chosen;
3291 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3292 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3293
3294 if (max_results < 1)
3295 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3296 if (nsyms <= 1)
3297 return nsyms;
3298
3299 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3300 error (_("\
3301 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3302 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3303
3304 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3305 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3306 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3307 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3308 return nsyms;
3309
3310 printf_unfiltered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3311 if (max_results > 1)
3312 printf_unfiltered (_("[1] all\n"));
3313
3314 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3315
3316 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3317 {
3318 if (syms[i].sym == NULL)
3319 continue;
3320
3321 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_BLOCK)
3322 {
3323 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3324 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].sym, 1);
3325 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3326 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at <no source file available>:%d\n"),
3327 i + first_choice,
3328 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3329 sal.line);
3330 else
3331 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"), i + first_choice,
3332 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3333 sal.symtab->filename, sal.line);
3334 continue;
3335 }
3336 else
3337 {
3338 int is_enumeral =
3339 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_CONST
3340 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym) != NULL
3341 && TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3342 struct symtab *symtab = syms[i].sym->symtab;
3343
3344 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3345 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"),
3346 i + first_choice,
3347 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3348 symtab->filename, SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym));
3349 else if (is_enumeral
3350 && TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != NULL)
3351 {
3352 printf_unfiltered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3353 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym), NULL,
3354 gdb_stdout, -1, 0);
3355 printf_unfiltered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3356 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3357 }
3358 else if (symtab != NULL)
3359 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3360 ? _("[%d] %s in %s (enumeral)\n")
3361 : _("[%d] %s at %s:?\n"),
3362 i + first_choice,
3363 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3364 symtab->filename);
3365 else
3366 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3367 ? _("[%d] %s (enumeral)\n")
3368 : _("[%d] %s at ?\n"),
3369 i + first_choice,
3370 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3371 }
3372 }
3373
3374 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3375 "overload-choice");
3376
3377 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3378 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3379
3380 return n_chosen;
3381 }
3382
3383 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3384 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3385 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3386
3387 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3388 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3389
3390 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3391 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3392 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3393
3394 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3395
3396 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3397 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3398
3399 int
3400 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3401 int is_all_choice, char *annotation_suffix)
3402 {
3403 char *args;
3404 char *prompt;
3405 int n_chosen;
3406 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3407
3408 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3409 if (prompt == NULL)
3410 prompt = "> ";
3411
3412 args = command_line_input (prompt, 0, annotation_suffix);
3413
3414 if (args == NULL)
3415 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3416
3417 n_chosen = 0;
3418
3419 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3420 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3421 while (1)
3422 {
3423 char *args2;
3424 int choice, j;
3425
3426 while (isspace (*args))
3427 args += 1;
3428 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3429 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3430 else if (*args == '\0')
3431 break;
3432
3433 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3434 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3435 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3436 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3437 args = args2;
3438
3439 if (choice == 0)
3440 error (_("cancelled"));
3441
3442 if (choice < first_choice)
3443 {
3444 n_chosen = n_choices;
3445 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3446 choices[j] = j;
3447 break;
3448 }
3449 choice -= first_choice;
3450
3451 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3452 {
3453 }
3454
3455 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3456 {
3457 int k;
3458 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3459 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3460 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3461 n_chosen += 1;
3462 }
3463 }
3464
3465 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3466 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3467
3468 return n_chosen;
3469 }
3470
3471 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
3472 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
3473 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
3474
3475 static void
3476 replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **expp, int pc, int nargs,
3477 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
3478 struct block *block)
3479 {
3480 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
3481 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
3482 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
3483 xmalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
3484 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
3485 struct expression *exp = *expp;
3486
3487 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
3488 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
3489 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
3490 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
3491 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
3492
3493 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
3494 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
3495
3496 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
3497 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
3498 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
3499
3500 *expp = newexp;
3501 xfree (exp);
3502 }
3503
3504 /* Type-class predicates */
3505
3506 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
3507 or FLOAT). */
3508
3509 static int
3510 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
3511 {
3512 if (type == NULL)
3513 return 0;
3514 else
3515 {
3516 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3517 {
3518 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3519 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3520 return 1;
3521 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3522 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3523 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3524 default:
3525 return 0;
3526 }
3527 }
3528 }
3529
3530 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
3531
3532 static int
3533 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
3534 {
3535 if (type == NULL)
3536 return 0;
3537 else
3538 {
3539 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3540 {
3541 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3542 return 1;
3543 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3544 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3545 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3546 default:
3547 return 0;
3548 }
3549 }
3550 }
3551
3552 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
3553
3554 static int
3555 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
3556 {
3557 if (type == NULL)
3558 return 0;
3559 else
3560 {
3561 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3562 {
3563 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3564 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3565 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3566 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3567 return 1;
3568 default:
3569 return 0;
3570 }
3571 }
3572 }
3573
3574 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
3575
3576 static int
3577 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
3578 {
3579 if (type == NULL)
3580 return 0;
3581 else
3582 {
3583 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3584 {
3585 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3586 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3587 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3588 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
3589 return 1;
3590 default:
3591 return 0;
3592 }
3593 }
3594 }
3595
3596 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
3597 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
3598 (i.e., result 0). */
3599
3600 static int
3601 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
3602 {
3603 struct type *type0 =
3604 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
3605 struct type *type1 =
3606 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
3607
3608 if (type0 == NULL)
3609 return 0;
3610
3611 switch (op)
3612 {
3613 default:
3614 return 0;
3615
3616 case BINOP_ADD:
3617 case BINOP_SUB:
3618 case BINOP_MUL:
3619 case BINOP_DIV:
3620 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
3621
3622 case BINOP_REM:
3623 case BINOP_MOD:
3624 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3625 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3626 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3627 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3628
3629 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3630 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3631 case BINOP_LESS:
3632 case BINOP_GTR:
3633 case BINOP_LEQ:
3634 case BINOP_GEQ:
3635 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
3636
3637 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3638 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
3639
3640 case BINOP_EXP:
3641 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3642
3643 case UNOP_NEG:
3644 case UNOP_PLUS:
3645 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3646 case UNOP_ABS:
3647 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
3648
3649 }
3650 }
3651 \f
3652 /* Renaming */
3653
3654 /* NOTES:
3655
3656 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
3657 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
3658 point.
3659 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
3660 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
3661 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
3662 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
3663 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
3664 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
3665
3666 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
3667
3668 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
3669
3670 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
3671 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
3672 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
3673 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
3674 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
3675 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
3676 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
3677 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
3678 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
3679 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
3680 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
3681 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
3682
3683 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
3684
3685 enum ada_renaming_category
3686 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
3687 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3688 const char **renaming_expr)
3689 {
3690 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3691 const char *info;
3692 const char *suffix;
3693
3694 if (sym == NULL)
3695 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3696 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
3697 {
3698 default:
3699 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3700 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
3701 return parse_old_style_renaming (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym),
3702 renamed_entity, len, renaming_expr);
3703 case LOC_LOCAL:
3704 case LOC_STATIC:
3705 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3706 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
3707 info = strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR");
3708 if (info == NULL)
3709 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3710 switch (info[5])
3711 {
3712 case '_':
3713 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3714 info += 6;
3715 break;
3716 case 'E':
3717 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3718 info += 7;
3719 break;
3720 case 'P':
3721 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3722 info += 7;
3723 break;
3724 case 'S':
3725 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3726 info += 7;
3727 break;
3728 default:
3729 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3730 }
3731 }
3732
3733 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3734 *renamed_entity = info;
3735 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3736 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3737 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3738 if (len != NULL)
3739 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
3740 suffix += 5;
3741 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3742 *renaming_expr = suffix;
3743 return kind;
3744 }
3745
3746 /* Assuming TYPE encodes a renaming according to the old encoding in
3747 exp_dbug.ads, returns details of that renaming in *RENAMED_ENTITY,
3748 *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR, as for ada_parse_renaming, above. Returns
3749 ADA_NOT_RENAMING otherwise. */
3750 static enum ada_renaming_category
3751 parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *type,
3752 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3753 const char **renaming_expr)
3754 {
3755 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3756 const char *name;
3757 const char *info;
3758 const char *suffix;
3759
3760 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
3761 || TYPE_NFIELDS (type) != 1)
3762 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3763
3764 name = type_name_no_tag (type);
3765 if (name == NULL)
3766 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3767
3768 name = strstr (name, "___XR");
3769 if (name == NULL)
3770 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3771 switch (name[5])
3772 {
3773 case '\0':
3774 case '_':
3775 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3776 break;
3777 case 'E':
3778 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3779 break;
3780 case 'P':
3781 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3782 break;
3783 case 'S':
3784 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3785 break;
3786 default:
3787 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3788 }
3789
3790 info = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0);
3791 if (info == NULL)
3792 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3793 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3794 *renamed_entity = info;
3795 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3796 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3797 *renaming_expr = suffix + 5;
3798 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3799 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3800 if (len != NULL)
3801 *len = suffix - info;
3802 return kind;
3803 }
3804
3805 \f
3806
3807 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
3808
3809 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
3810 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of pushing a copy of VAL
3811 on the stack, using and updating *SP as the stack pointer, and
3812 returning an lvalue whose value_address points to the copy. */
3813
3814 static struct value *
3815 ensure_lval (struct value *val, struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR *sp)
3816 {
3817 if (! VALUE_LVAL (val))
3818 {
3819 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
3820
3821 /* The following is taken from the structure-return code in
3822 call_function_by_hand. FIXME: Therefore, some refactoring seems
3823 indicated. */
3824 if (gdbarch_inner_than (gdbarch, 1, 2))
3825 {
3826 /* Stack grows downward. Align SP and value_address (val) after
3827 reserving sufficient space. */
3828 *sp -= len;
3829 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (gdbarch))
3830 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (gdbarch, *sp);
3831 set_value_address (val, *sp);
3832 }
3833 else
3834 {
3835 /* Stack grows upward. Align the frame, allocate space, and
3836 then again, re-align the frame. */
3837 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (gdbarch))
3838 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (gdbarch, *sp);
3839 set_value_address (val, *sp);
3840 *sp += len;
3841 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (gdbarch))
3842 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (gdbarch, *sp);
3843 }
3844 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
3845
3846 write_memory (value_address (val), value_contents_raw (val), len);
3847 }
3848
3849 return val;
3850 }
3851
3852 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
3853 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
3854 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
3855 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
3856
3857 struct value *
3858 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0,
3859 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR *sp)
3860 {
3861 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
3862 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
3863 struct type *formal_target =
3864 TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3865 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
3866 struct type *actual_target =
3867 TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3868 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
3869
3870 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
3871 && TYPE_CODE (actual_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
3872 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual, gdbarch, sp);
3873 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3874 || TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3875 {
3876 struct value *result;
3877 if (TYPE_CODE (formal_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3878 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
3879 result = desc_data (actual);
3880 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3881 {
3882 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
3883 {
3884 struct value *val;
3885 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
3886 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
3887 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
3888 (char *) value_contents (actual),
3889 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
3890 actual = ensure_lval (val, gdbarch, sp);
3891 }
3892 result = value_addr (actual);
3893 }
3894 else
3895 return actual;
3896 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result);
3897 }
3898 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3899 return ada_value_ind (actual);
3900
3901 return actual;
3902 }
3903
3904
3905 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
3906 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
3907 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
3908 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
3909 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
3910
3911 static struct value *
3912 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr,
3913 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR *sp)
3914 {
3915 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
3916 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
3917 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
3918 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
3919 int i;
3920
3921 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))); i > 0; i -= 1)
3922 {
3923 modify_general_field (value_type (bounds),
3924 value_contents_writeable (bounds),
3925 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0),
3926 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
3927 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
3928 modify_general_field (value_type (bounds),
3929 value_contents_writeable (bounds),
3930 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1),
3931 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
3932 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
3933 }
3934
3935 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds, gdbarch, sp);
3936
3937 modify_general_field (value_type (descriptor),
3938 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
3939 value_address (ensure_lval (arr, gdbarch, sp)),
3940 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
3941 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
3942
3943 modify_general_field (value_type (descriptor),
3944 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
3945 value_address (bounds),
3946 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
3947 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
3948
3949 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor, gdbarch, sp);
3950
3951 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3952 return value_addr (descriptor);
3953 else
3954 return descriptor;
3955 }
3956 \f
3957 /* Dummy definitions for an experimental caching module that is not
3958 * used in the public sources. */
3959
3960 static int
3961 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
3962 struct symbol **sym, struct block **block)
3963 {
3964 return 0;
3965 }
3966
3967 static void
3968 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace, struct symbol *sym,
3969 struct block *block)
3970 {
3971 }
3972 \f
3973 /* Symbol Lookup */
3974
3975 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
3976 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
3977
3978 static struct symbol *
3979 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
3980 domain_enum domain)
3981 {
3982 struct symbol *sym;
3983
3984 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym, NULL))
3985 return sym;
3986 sym = lookup_symbol_in_language (name, block, domain, language_c, 0);
3987 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym, block_found);
3988 return sym;
3989 }
3990
3991
3992 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
3993 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
3994 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
3995 static int
3996 is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int n)
3997 {
3998 int i;
3999
4000 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
4001 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
4002 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4003 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) != LOC_CONST))
4004 return 1;
4005
4006 return 0;
4007 }
4008
4009 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
4010 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
4011
4012 static int
4013 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
4014 {
4015 if (type0 == type1)
4016 return 1;
4017 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
4018 || TYPE_CODE (type0) != TYPE_CODE (type1))
4019 return 0;
4020 if ((TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
4021 || TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4022 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
4023 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
4024 return 1;
4025
4026 return 0;
4027 }
4028
4029 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
4030 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
4031
4032 static int
4033 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
4034 {
4035 if (sym0 == sym1)
4036 return 1;
4037 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
4038 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
4039 return 0;
4040
4041 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
4042 {
4043 case LOC_UNDEF:
4044 return 1;
4045 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4046 {
4047 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
4048 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
4049 char *name0 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym0);
4050 char *name1 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym1);
4051 int len0 = strlen (name0);
4052 return
4053 TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE (type1)
4054 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
4055 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
4056 && strncmp (name1 + len0, "___XV", 5) == 0));
4057 }
4058 case LOC_CONST:
4059 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
4060 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
4061 default:
4062 return 0;
4063 }
4064 }
4065
4066 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct ada_symbol_info
4067 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
4068
4069 static void
4070 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4071 struct symbol *sym,
4072 struct block *block)
4073 {
4074 int i;
4075 size_t tmp;
4076 struct ada_symbol_info *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4077
4078 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4079 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4080 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4081 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4082 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4083 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4084 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4085 out the stub ones if needed. */
4086
4087 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4088 {
4089 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].sym))
4090 return;
4091 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].sym, sym))
4092 {
4093 prevDefns[i].sym = sym;
4094 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4095 return;
4096 }
4097 }
4098
4099 {
4100 struct ada_symbol_info info;
4101
4102 info.sym = sym;
4103 info.block = block;
4104 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
4105 }
4106 }
4107
4108 /* Number of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in
4109 current vector in *OBSTACKP. */
4110
4111 static int
4112 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4113 {
4114 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info);
4115 }
4116
4117 /* Vector of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in current
4118 vector in *OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return
4119 its final address. */
4120
4121 static struct ada_symbol_info *
4122 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4123 {
4124 if (finish)
4125 return obstack_finish (obstackp);
4126 else
4127 return (struct ada_symbol_info *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4128 }
4129
4130 /* Look, in partial_symtab PST, for symbol NAME in given namespace.
4131 Check the global symbols if GLOBAL, the static symbols if not.
4132 Do wild-card match if WILD. */
4133
4134 static struct partial_symbol *
4135 ada_lookup_partial_symbol (struct partial_symtab *pst, const char *name,
4136 int global, domain_enum namespace, int wild)
4137 {
4138 struct partial_symbol **start;
4139 int name_len = strlen (name);
4140 int length = (global ? pst->n_global_syms : pst->n_static_syms);
4141 int i;
4142
4143 if (length == 0)
4144 {
4145 return (NULL);
4146 }
4147
4148 start = (global ?
4149 pst->objfile->global_psymbols.list + pst->globals_offset :
4150 pst->objfile->static_psymbols.list + pst->statics_offset);
4151
4152 if (wild)
4153 {
4154 for (i = 0; i < length; i += 1)
4155 {
4156 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4157
4158 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4159 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace)
4160 && wild_match (name, name_len, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)))
4161 return psym;
4162 }
4163 return NULL;
4164 }
4165 else
4166 {
4167 if (global)
4168 {
4169 int U;
4170 i = 0;
4171 U = length - 1;
4172 while (U - i > 4)
4173 {
4174 int M = (U + i) >> 1;
4175 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[M];
4176 if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] < name[0])
4177 i = M + 1;
4178 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] > name[0])
4179 U = M - 1;
4180 else if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), name) < 0)
4181 i = M + 1;
4182 else
4183 U = M;
4184 }
4185 }
4186 else
4187 i = 0;
4188
4189 while (i < length)
4190 {
4191 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4192
4193 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4194 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace))
4195 {
4196 int cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), name_len);
4197
4198 if (cmp < 0)
4199 {
4200 if (global)
4201 break;
4202 }
4203 else if (cmp == 0
4204 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)
4205 + name_len))
4206 return psym;
4207 }
4208 i += 1;
4209 }
4210
4211 if (global)
4212 {
4213 int U;
4214 i = 0;
4215 U = length - 1;
4216 while (U - i > 4)
4217 {
4218 int M = (U + i) >> 1;
4219 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[M];
4220 if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] < '_')
4221 i = M + 1;
4222 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] > '_')
4223 U = M - 1;
4224 else if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), "_ada_") < 0)
4225 i = M + 1;
4226 else
4227 U = M;
4228 }
4229 }
4230 else
4231 i = 0;
4232
4233 while (i < length)
4234 {
4235 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4236
4237 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4238 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace))
4239 {
4240 int cmp;
4241
4242 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0];
4243 if (cmp == 0)
4244 {
4245 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), 5);
4246 if (cmp == 0)
4247 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym) + 5,
4248 name_len);
4249 }
4250
4251 if (cmp < 0)
4252 {
4253 if (global)
4254 break;
4255 }
4256 else if (cmp == 0
4257 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)
4258 + name_len + 5))
4259 return psym;
4260 }
4261 i += 1;
4262 }
4263 }
4264 return NULL;
4265 }
4266
4267 /* Return a minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada decoding
4268 rules. Returns NULL if there is no such minimal symbol. Names
4269 prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__" is
4270 first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4271
4272 struct minimal_symbol *
4273 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4274 {
4275 struct objfile *objfile;
4276 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
4277 int wild_match;
4278
4279 if (strncmp (name, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4280 {
4281 name += sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4282 wild_match = 0;
4283 }
4284 else
4285 wild_match = (strstr (name, "__") == NULL);
4286
4287 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
4288 {
4289 if (ada_match_name (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), name, wild_match)
4290 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4291 return msymbol;
4292 }
4293
4294 return NULL;
4295 }
4296
4297 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4298 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4299 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4300 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD, treat as NAME with a
4301 wildcard prefix. */
4302
4303 static void
4304 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4305 const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
4306 int wild_match)
4307 {
4308 }
4309
4310 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4311 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4312
4313 static int
4314 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4315 {
4316 char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4317 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4318 }
4319
4320 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS[0 .. NSYMS-1] that definitely
4321 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
4322 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
4323 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
4324 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
4325 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
4326
4327 static int
4328 remove_extra_symbols (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4329 {
4330 int i, j;
4331
4332 i = 0;
4333 while (i < nsyms)
4334 {
4335 int remove = 0;
4336
4337 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type,
4338 the get rid of the stub. */
4339
4340 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4341 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL)
4342 {
4343 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j++)
4344 {
4345 if (j != i
4346 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[j].sym))
4347 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4348 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4349 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0)
4350 remove = 1;
4351 }
4352 }
4353
4354 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address
4355 should be identical. */
4356
4357 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL
4358 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_STATIC
4359 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)))
4360 {
4361 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4362 {
4363 if (i != j
4364 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4365 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4366 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0
4367 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[j].sym)
4368 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[i].sym)
4369 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[j].sym))
4370 remove = 1;
4371 }
4372 }
4373
4374 if (remove)
4375 {
4376 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4377 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4378 nsyms -= 1;
4379 }
4380
4381 i += 1;
4382 }
4383 return nsyms;
4384 }
4385
4386 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
4387 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
4388 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
4389 defined. The string returned needs to be deallocated after use. */
4390
4391 static char *
4392 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
4393 {
4394 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
4395 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
4396 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
4397 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
4398
4399 const char *name = type_name_no_tag (renaming_type);
4400 char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4401 char *last;
4402 int scope_len;
4403 char *scope;
4404
4405 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
4406 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
4407
4408 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
4409 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
4410 break;
4411
4412 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
4413
4414 scope_len = last - name;
4415 scope = (char *) xmalloc ((scope_len + 1) * sizeof (char));
4416
4417 strncpy (scope, name, scope_len);
4418 scope[scope_len] = '\0';
4419
4420 return scope;
4421 }
4422
4423 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
4424
4425 static int
4426 is_package_name (const char *name)
4427 {
4428 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
4429 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
4430 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
4431 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
4432 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
4433
4434 char *fun_name;
4435
4436 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
4437 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
4438 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
4439 return 0;
4440
4441 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
4442 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
4443
4444 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
4445 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
4446 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
4447 return 0;
4448
4449 fun_name = xstrprintf ("_ada_%s", name);
4450
4451 return (standard_lookup (fun_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
4452 }
4453
4454 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
4455 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
4456
4457 static int
4458 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, char *function_name)
4459 {
4460 char *scope;
4461
4462 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
4463 return 0;
4464
4465 scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
4466
4467 make_cleanup (xfree, scope);
4468
4469 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
4470 if (is_package_name (scope))
4471 return 0;
4472
4473 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
4474 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
4475
4476 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
4477 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
4478 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
4479 this prefix. */
4480 if (strncmp (function_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
4481 function_name += 5;
4482
4483 return (strncmp (function_name, scope, strlen (scope)) != 0);
4484 }
4485
4486 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
4487 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
4488 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
4489 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
4490 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
4491
4492 Rationale:
4493 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
4494 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
4495 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
4496 latter.
4497
4498 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
4499 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
4500 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
4501 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
4502 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
4503 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
4504 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
4505
4506 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
4507 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
4508 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
4509 method with the current information available. The implementation
4510 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
4511
4512 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
4513 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
4514 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
4515 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
4516 currently not the case.
4517
4518 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
4519 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
4520 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
4521 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
4522
4523 static int
4524 remove_irrelevant_renamings (struct ada_symbol_info *syms,
4525 int nsyms, const struct block *current_block)
4526 {
4527 struct symbol *current_function;
4528 char *current_function_name;
4529 int i;
4530 int is_new_style_renaming;
4531
4532 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
4533 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
4534 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
4535 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
4536 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
4537 {
4538 struct symbol *sym = syms[i].sym;
4539 struct block *block = syms[i].block;
4540 const char *name;
4541 const char *suffix;
4542
4543 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
4544 continue;
4545 name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym);
4546 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4547
4548 if (suffix != NULL)
4549 {
4550 int name_len = suffix - name;
4551 int j;
4552 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
4553 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4554 if (i != j && syms[j].sym != NULL
4555 && strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
4556 name_len) == 0
4557 && block == syms[j].block)
4558 syms[j].sym = NULL;
4559 }
4560 }
4561 if (is_new_style_renaming)
4562 {
4563 int j, k;
4564
4565 for (j = k = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4566 if (syms[j].sym != NULL)
4567 {
4568 syms[k] = syms[j];
4569 k += 1;
4570 }
4571 return k;
4572 }
4573
4574 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
4575 Abort if unable to do so. */
4576
4577 if (current_block == NULL)
4578 return nsyms;
4579
4580 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block);
4581 if (current_function == NULL)
4582 return nsyms;
4583
4584 current_function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (current_function);
4585 if (current_function_name == NULL)
4586 return nsyms;
4587
4588 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
4589 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
4590 the current block. */
4591
4592 i = 0;
4593 while (i < nsyms)
4594 {
4595 if (ada_parse_renaming (syms[i].sym, NULL, NULL, NULL)
4596 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
4597 && old_renaming_is_invisible (syms[i].sym, current_function_name))
4598 {
4599 int j;
4600 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4601 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4602 nsyms -= 1;
4603 }
4604 else
4605 i += 1;
4606 }
4607
4608 return nsyms;
4609 }
4610
4611 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks)
4612 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively.
4613 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing"
4614 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function,
4615 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions).
4616
4617 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */
4618
4619 static void
4620 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
4621 struct block *block, domain_enum domain,
4622 int wild_match)
4623 {
4624 int block_depth = 0;
4625
4626 while (block != NULL)
4627 {
4628 block_depth += 1;
4629 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, name, domain, NULL, wild_match);
4630
4631 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
4632 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0),
4633 num_defns_collected (obstackp)))
4634 return;
4635
4636 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
4637 }
4638
4639 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
4640 enclosing subprogram. */
4641 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
4642 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, name, domain, wild_match);
4643 }
4644
4645 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match
4646 NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on GLOBAL_BLOCK
4647 symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK symbols otherwise. */
4648
4649 static void
4650 ada_add_non_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
4651 domain_enum domain, int global,
4652 int wild_match)
4653 {
4654 struct objfile *objfile;
4655 struct partial_symtab *ps;
4656
4657 ALL_PSYMTABS (objfile, ps)
4658 {
4659 QUIT;
4660 if (ps->readin
4661 || ada_lookup_partial_symbol (ps, name, global, domain, wild_match))
4662 {
4663 struct symtab *s = PSYMTAB_TO_SYMTAB (ps);
4664 const int block_kind = global ? GLOBAL_BLOCK : STATIC_BLOCK;
4665
4666 if (s == NULL || !s->primary)
4667 continue;
4668 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp,
4669 BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), block_kind),
4670 name, domain, objfile, wild_match);
4671 }
4672 }
4673 }
4674
4675 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
4676 scope and in global scopes, returning the number of matches. Sets
4677 *RESULTS to point to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples,
4678 indicating the symbols found and the blocks and symbol tables (if
4679 any) in which they were found. This vector are transient---good only to
4680 the next call of ada_lookup_symbol_list. Any non-function/non-enumeral
4681 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK0,
4682 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
4683 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
4684 surrounding BLOCK0, then these alone are returned. Otherwise, the
4685 search extends to global and file-scope (static) symbol tables.
4686 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
4687 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4688
4689 int
4690 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name0, const struct block *block0,
4691 domain_enum namespace,
4692 struct ada_symbol_info **results)
4693 {
4694 struct symbol *sym;
4695 struct block *block;
4696 const char *name;
4697 int wild_match;
4698 int cacheIfUnique;
4699 int ndefns;
4700
4701 obstack_free (&symbol_list_obstack, NULL);
4702 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
4703
4704 cacheIfUnique = 0;
4705
4706 /* Search specified block and its superiors. */
4707
4708 wild_match = (strstr (name0, "__") == NULL);
4709 name = name0;
4710 block = (struct block *) block0; /* FIXME: No cast ought to be
4711 needed, but adding const will
4712 have a cascade effect. */
4713
4714 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
4715 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
4716 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
4717 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
4718 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
4719 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
4720 entity inside its program). */
4721 if (strncmp (name0, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4722 {
4723 wild_match = 0;
4724 block = NULL;
4725 name = name0 + sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4726 }
4727
4728 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */
4729
4730 ada_add_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, block, namespace,
4731 wild_match);
4732 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) > 0)
4733 goto done;
4734
4735 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have
4736 already performed this search before. If we have, then return
4737 the same result. */
4738
4739 cacheIfUnique = 1;
4740 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name0, namespace, &sym, &block))
4741 {
4742 if (sym != NULL)
4743 add_defn_to_vec (&symbol_list_obstack, sym, block);
4744 goto done;
4745 }
4746
4747 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */
4748
4749 ada_add_non_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 1,
4750 wild_match);
4751
4752 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
4753 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */
4754
4755 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) == 0)
4756 ada_add_non_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 0,
4757 wild_match);
4758
4759 done:
4760 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack);
4761 *results = defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack, 1);
4762
4763 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (*results, ndefns);
4764
4765 if (ndefns == 0)
4766 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, NULL, NULL);
4767
4768 if (ndefns == 1 && cacheIfUnique)
4769 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, (*results)[0].sym, (*results)[0].block);
4770
4771 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (*results, ndefns, block0);
4772
4773 return ndefns;
4774 }
4775
4776 struct symbol *
4777 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
4778 domain_enum namespace, struct block **block_found)
4779 {
4780 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
4781 int n_candidates;
4782
4783 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block0, namespace, &candidates);
4784
4785 if (n_candidates == 0)
4786 return NULL;
4787
4788 if (block_found != NULL)
4789 *block_found = candidates[0].block;
4790
4791 return fixup_symbol_section (candidates[0].sym, NULL);
4792 }
4793
4794 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
4795 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
4796 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
4797 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices.
4798 *IS_A_FIELD_OF_THIS is set to 0 and *SYMTAB is set to the symbol
4799 table in which the symbol was found (in both cases, these
4800 assignments occur only if the pointers are non-null). */
4801 struct symbol *
4802 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
4803 domain_enum namespace, int *is_a_field_of_this)
4804 {
4805 if (is_a_field_of_this != NULL)
4806 *is_a_field_of_this = 0;
4807
4808 return
4809 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)),
4810 block0, namespace, NULL);
4811 }
4812
4813 static struct symbol *
4814 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const char *name,
4815 const char *linkage_name,
4816 const struct block *block,
4817 const domain_enum domain)
4818 {
4819 if (linkage_name == NULL)
4820 linkage_name = name;
4821 return ada_lookup_symbol (linkage_name, block_static_block (block), domain,
4822 NULL);
4823 }
4824
4825
4826 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
4827 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
4828 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
4829 are given by any of the regular expressions:
4830
4831 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
4832 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
4833 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
4834 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
4835
4836 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
4837 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
4838 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
4839
4840 static int
4841 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
4842 {
4843 int k;
4844 const char *matching;
4845 const int len = strlen (str);
4846
4847 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
4848
4849 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
4850 {
4851 str += 3;
4852 while (isdigit (str[0]))
4853 str += 1;
4854 }
4855
4856 /* [.$][0-9]+ */
4857
4858 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
4859 {
4860 matching = str + 1;
4861 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4862 matching += 1;
4863 if (matching[0] == '\0')
4864 return 1;
4865 }
4866
4867 /* ___[0-9]+ */
4868
4869 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
4870 {
4871 matching = str + 3;
4872 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4873 matching += 1;
4874 if (matching[0] == '\0')
4875 return 1;
4876 }
4877
4878 #if 0
4879 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
4880 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
4881 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
4882 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
4883 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
4884 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
4885 name ends with N.
4886 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
4887 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
4888 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
4889 the following check. */
4890 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
4891 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
4892 return 1;
4893 #endif
4894
4895 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */
4896 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
4897 {
4898 matching = str + 3;
4899 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4900 matching += 1;
4901 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
4902 && matching [1] == '\0')
4903 return 1;
4904 }
4905
4906 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
4907 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
4908 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
4909 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
4910 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
4911 if (str[0] == 'X')
4912 {
4913 str += 1;
4914 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
4915 {
4916 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
4917 return 0;
4918 str += 1;
4919 }
4920 }
4921
4922 if (str[0] == '\000')
4923 return 1;
4924
4925 if (str[0] == '_')
4926 {
4927 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
4928 return 0;
4929 if (str[2] == '_')
4930 {
4931 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
4932 return 1;
4933 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
4934 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
4935 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
4936 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
4937 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
4938 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
4939 return 1;
4940 if (str[3] != 'X')
4941 return 0;
4942 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
4943 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
4944 return 1;
4945 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
4946 return 1;
4947 return 0;
4948 }
4949 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
4950 return 0;
4951 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
4952 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
4953 return 0;
4954 return 1;
4955 }
4956 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
4957 {
4958 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
4959 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
4960 return 0;
4961 return 1;
4962 }
4963 return 0;
4964 }
4965
4966 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
4967 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
4968
4969 static int
4970 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
4971 {
4972 const char *decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
4973 int i;
4974
4975 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that
4976 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then
4977 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */
4978 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
4979 return 0;
4980
4981 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
4982 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
4983 return 0;
4984
4985 return 1;
4986 }
4987
4988 /* True if NAME represents a name of the form A1.A2....An, n>=1 and
4989 PATN[0..PATN_LEN-1] = Ak.Ak+1.....An for some k >= 1. Ignores
4990 informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which is_name_suffix is
4991 true). */
4992
4993 static int
4994 wild_match (const char *patn0, int patn_len, const char *name0)
4995 {
4996 char* match;
4997 const char* start;
4998 start = name0;
4999 while (1)
5000 {
5001 match = strstr (start, patn0);
5002 if (match == NULL)
5003 return 0;
5004 if ((match == name0
5005 || match[-1] == '.'
5006 || (match > name0 + 1 && match[-1] == '_' && match[-2] == '_')
5007 || (match == name0 + 5 && strncmp ("_ada_", name0, 5) == 0))
5008 && is_name_suffix (match + patn_len))
5009 return (match == name0 || is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0));
5010 start = match + 1;
5011 }
5012 }
5013
5014 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN to
5015 vector *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP
5016 (if necessary). If WILD, treat as NAME with a wildcard prefix.
5017 OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK.
5018 SYMTAB is recorded with each symbol added. */
5019
5020 static void
5021 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5022 struct block *block, const char *name,
5023 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile,
5024 int wild)
5025 {
5026 struct dict_iterator iter;
5027 int name_len = strlen (name);
5028 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
5029 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5030 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
5031 int found_sym;
5032 struct symbol *sym;
5033
5034 arg_sym = NULL;
5035 found_sym = 0;
5036 if (wild)
5037 {
5038 struct symbol *sym;
5039 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5040 {
5041 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5042 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain)
5043 && wild_match (name, name_len, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)))
5044 {
5045 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5046 continue;
5047 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5048 arg_sym = sym;
5049 else
5050 {
5051 found_sym = 1;
5052 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5053 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5054 block);
5055 }
5056 }
5057 }
5058 }
5059 else
5060 {
5061 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5062 {
5063 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5064 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5065 {
5066 int cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), name_len);
5067 if (cmp == 0
5068 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len))
5069 {
5070 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5071 {
5072 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5073 arg_sym = sym;
5074 else
5075 {
5076 found_sym = 1;
5077 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5078 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5079 block);
5080 }
5081 }
5082 }
5083 }
5084 }
5085 }
5086
5087 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5088 {
5089 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5090 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5091 block);
5092 }
5093
5094 if (!wild)
5095 {
5096 arg_sym = NULL;
5097 found_sym = 0;
5098
5099 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5100 {
5101 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5102 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5103 {
5104 int cmp;
5105
5106 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)[0];
5107 if (cmp == 0)
5108 {
5109 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), 5);
5110 if (cmp == 0)
5111 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + 5,
5112 name_len);
5113 }
5114
5115 if (cmp == 0
5116 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len + 5))
5117 {
5118 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5119 {
5120 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5121 arg_sym = sym;
5122 else
5123 {
5124 found_sym = 1;
5125 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5126 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5127 block);
5128 }
5129 }
5130 }
5131 }
5132 }
5133
5134 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
5135 They aren't parameters, right? */
5136 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5137 {
5138 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5139 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5140 block);
5141 }
5142 }
5143 }
5144 \f
5145
5146 /* Symbol Completion */
5147
5148 /* If SYM_NAME is a completion candidate for TEXT, return this symbol
5149 name in a form that's appropriate for the completion. The result
5150 does not need to be deallocated, but is only good until the next call.
5151
5152 TEXT_LEN is equal to the length of TEXT.
5153 Perform a wild match if WILD_MATCH is set.
5154 ENCODED should be set if TEXT represents the start of a symbol name
5155 in its encoded form. */
5156
5157 static const char *
5158 symbol_completion_match (const char *sym_name,
5159 const char *text, int text_len,
5160 int wild_match, int encoded)
5161 {
5162 char *result;
5163 const int verbatim_match = (text[0] == '<');
5164 int match = 0;
5165
5166 if (verbatim_match)
5167 {
5168 /* Strip the leading angle bracket. */
5169 text = text + 1;
5170 text_len--;
5171 }
5172
5173 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
5174
5175 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5176 match = 1;
5177
5178 if (match && !encoded)
5179 {
5180 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
5181 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
5182 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
5183 is not a suitable completion. */
5184 const char *sym_name_copy = sym_name;
5185 int has_angle_bracket;
5186
5187 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5188 has_angle_bracket = (sym_name[0] == '<');
5189 match = (has_angle_bracket == verbatim_match);
5190 sym_name = sym_name_copy;
5191 }
5192
5193 if (match && !verbatim_match)
5194 {
5195 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
5196 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
5197 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
5198 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
5199 angle bracket notation. */
5200 const char *tmp;
5201
5202 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
5203 if (*tmp != '\0')
5204 match = 0;
5205 }
5206
5207 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
5208
5209 if (!match && wild_match)
5210 {
5211 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
5212 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
5213 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
5214 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (ada_decode (sym_name));
5215
5216 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5217 match = 1;
5218 }
5219
5220 /* Finally: If we found a mach, prepare the result to return. */
5221
5222 if (!match)
5223 return NULL;
5224
5225 if (verbatim_match)
5226 sym_name = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
5227
5228 if (!encoded)
5229 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5230
5231 return sym_name;
5232 }
5233
5234 typedef char *char_ptr;
5235 DEF_VEC_P (char_ptr);
5236
5237 /* A companion function to ada_make_symbol_completion_list().
5238 Check if SYM_NAME represents a symbol which name would be suitable
5239 to complete TEXT (TEXT_LEN is the length of TEXT), in which case
5240 it is appended at the end of the given string vector SV.
5241
5242 ORIG_TEXT is the string original string from the user command
5243 that needs to be completed. WORD is the entire command on which
5244 completion should be performed. These two parameters are used to
5245 determine which part of the symbol name should be added to the
5246 completion vector.
5247 if WILD_MATCH is set, then wild matching is performed.
5248 ENCODED should be set if TEXT represents a symbol name in its
5249 encoded formed (in which case the completion should also be
5250 encoded). */
5251
5252 static void
5253 symbol_completion_add (VEC(char_ptr) **sv,
5254 const char *sym_name,
5255 const char *text, int text_len,
5256 const char *orig_text, const char *word,
5257 int wild_match, int encoded)
5258 {
5259 const char *match = symbol_completion_match (sym_name, text, text_len,
5260 wild_match, encoded);
5261 char *completion;
5262
5263 if (match == NULL)
5264 return;
5265
5266 /* We found a match, so add the appropriate completion to the given
5267 string vector. */
5268
5269 if (word == orig_text)
5270 {
5271 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5272 strcpy (completion, match);
5273 }
5274 else if (word > orig_text)
5275 {
5276 /* Return some portion of sym_name. */
5277 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5278 strcpy (completion, match + (word - orig_text));
5279 }
5280 else
5281 {
5282 /* Return some of ORIG_TEXT plus sym_name. */
5283 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + (orig_text - word) + 5);
5284 strncpy (completion, word, orig_text - word);
5285 completion[orig_text - word] = '\0';
5286 strcat (completion, match);
5287 }
5288
5289 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, *sv, completion);
5290 }
5291
5292 /* Return a list of possible symbol names completing TEXT0. The list
5293 is NULL terminated. WORD is the entire command on which completion
5294 is made. */
5295
5296 static char **
5297 ada_make_symbol_completion_list (char *text0, char *word)
5298 {
5299 char *text;
5300 int text_len;
5301 int wild_match;
5302 int encoded;
5303 VEC(char_ptr) *completions = VEC_alloc (char_ptr, 128);
5304 struct symbol *sym;
5305 struct symtab *s;
5306 struct partial_symtab *ps;
5307 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
5308 struct objfile *objfile;
5309 struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
5310 int i;
5311 struct dict_iterator iter;
5312
5313 if (text0[0] == '<')
5314 {
5315 text = xstrdup (text0);
5316 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5317 text_len = strlen (text);
5318 wild_match = 0;
5319 encoded = 1;
5320 }
5321 else
5322 {
5323 text = xstrdup (ada_encode (text0));
5324 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5325 text_len = strlen (text);
5326 for (i = 0; i < text_len; i++)
5327 text[i] = tolower (text[i]);
5328
5329 encoded = (strstr (text0, "__") != NULL);
5330 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
5331 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
5332 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks like
5333 an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild mode. */
5334 wild_match = (strchr (text0, '.') == NULL && !encoded);
5335 }
5336
5337 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
5338 ALL_PSYMTABS (objfile, ps)
5339 {
5340 struct partial_symbol **psym;
5341
5342 /* If the psymtab's been read in we'll get it when we search
5343 through the blockvector. */
5344 if (ps->readin)
5345 continue;
5346
5347 for (psym = objfile->global_psymbols.list + ps->globals_offset;
5348 psym < (objfile->global_psymbols.list + ps->globals_offset
5349 + ps->n_global_syms); psym++)
5350 {
5351 QUIT;
5352 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (*psym),
5353 text, text_len, text0, word,
5354 wild_match, encoded);
5355 }
5356
5357 for (psym = objfile->static_psymbols.list + ps->statics_offset;
5358 psym < (objfile->static_psymbols.list + ps->statics_offset
5359 + ps->n_static_syms); psym++)
5360 {
5361 QUIT;
5362 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (*psym),
5363 text, text_len, text0, word,
5364 wild_match, encoded);
5365 }
5366 }
5367
5368 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
5369 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
5370 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
5371 handled by the psymtab code above). */
5372
5373 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
5374 {
5375 QUIT;
5376 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol),
5377 text, text_len, text0, word, wild_match, encoded);
5378 }
5379
5380 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
5381 complete on local vars. */
5382
5383 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5384 {
5385 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5386 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
5387
5388 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5389 {
5390 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5391 text, text_len, text0, word,
5392 wild_match, encoded);
5393 }
5394 }
5395
5396 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
5397 symbols which match. */
5398
5399 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5400 {
5401 QUIT;
5402 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
5403 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5404 {
5405 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5406 text, text_len, text0, word,
5407 wild_match, encoded);
5408 }
5409 }
5410
5411 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5412 {
5413 QUIT;
5414 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
5415 /* Don't do this block twice. */
5416 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
5417 continue;
5418 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5419 {
5420 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5421 text, text_len, text0, word,
5422 wild_match, encoded);
5423 }
5424 }
5425
5426 /* Append the closing NULL entry. */
5427 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, completions, NULL);
5428
5429 /* Make a copy of the COMPLETIONS VEC before we free it, and then
5430 return the copy. It's unfortunate that we have to make a copy
5431 of an array that we're about to destroy, but there is nothing much
5432 we can do about it. Fortunately, it's typically not a very large
5433 array. */
5434 {
5435 const size_t completions_size =
5436 VEC_length (char_ptr, completions) * sizeof (char *);
5437 char **result = malloc (completions_size);
5438
5439 memcpy (result, VEC_address (char_ptr, completions), completions_size);
5440
5441 VEC_free (char_ptr, completions);
5442 return result;
5443 }
5444 }
5445
5446 /* Field Access */
5447
5448 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
5449 for tagged types. */
5450
5451 static int
5452 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
5453 {
5454 char *name;
5455
5456 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5457 return 0;
5458
5459 name = TYPE_NAME (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5460 if (name == NULL)
5461 return 0;
5462
5463 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5464 }
5465
5466 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
5467 to be invisible to users. */
5468
5469 int
5470 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5471 {
5472 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
5473 return 1;
5474
5475 /* Check the name of that field. */
5476 {
5477 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5478
5479 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
5480 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
5481 but we don't want to print the value of annonymous fields anyway. */
5482 if (name == NULL)
5483 return 1;
5484
5485 /* A field named "_parent" is internally generated by GNAT for
5486 tagged types, and should not be printed either. */
5487 if (name[0] == '_' && strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) != 0)
5488 return 1;
5489 }
5490
5491 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type, then ignore. */
5492 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
5493 && ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num)))
5494 return 1;
5495
5496 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
5497 return 0;
5498 }
5499
5500 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
5501 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
5502
5503 int
5504 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
5505 {
5506 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1, NULL) != NULL);
5507 }
5508
5509 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
5510
5511 int
5512 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
5513 {
5514 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5515 return 0;
5516 else
5517 {
5518 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5519 return (name != NULL
5520 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5521 }
5522 }
5523
5524 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
5525
5526 struct type *
5527 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
5528 {
5529 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0, NULL);
5530 }
5531
5532 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
5533
5534 struct value *
5535 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
5536 {
5537 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
5538 }
5539
5540 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
5541 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
5542 ADDRESS. */
5543
5544 static struct value *
5545 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
5546 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
5547 CORE_ADDR address)
5548 {
5549 int tag_byte_offset, dummy1, dummy2;
5550 struct type *tag_type;
5551 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
5552 NULL, NULL, NULL))
5553 {
5554 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
5555 ? NULL
5556 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
5557 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
5558
5559 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
5560 }
5561 return NULL;
5562 }
5563
5564 static struct type *
5565 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
5566 {
5567 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
5568 if (type_name != NULL)
5569 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
5570 return NULL;
5571 }
5572
5573 struct tag_args
5574 {
5575 struct value *tag;
5576 char *name;
5577 };
5578
5579
5580 static int ada_tag_name_1 (void *);
5581 static int ada_tag_name_2 (struct tag_args *);
5582
5583 /* Wrapper function used by ada_tag_name. Given a struct tag_args*
5584 value ARGS, sets ARGS->name to the tag name of ARGS->tag.
5585 The value stored in ARGS->name is valid until the next call to
5586 ada_tag_name_1. */
5587
5588 static int
5589 ada_tag_name_1 (void *args0)
5590 {
5591 struct tag_args *args = (struct tag_args *) args0;
5592 static char name[1024];
5593 char *p;
5594 struct value *val;
5595 args->name = NULL;
5596 val = ada_value_struct_elt (args->tag, "tsd", 1);
5597 if (val == NULL)
5598 return ada_tag_name_2 (args);
5599 val = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "expanded_name", 1);
5600 if (val == NULL)
5601 return 0;
5602 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
5603 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
5604 if (isalpha (*p))
5605 *p = tolower (*p);
5606 args->name = name;
5607 return 0;
5608 }
5609
5610 /* Utility function for ada_tag_name_1 that tries the second
5611 representation for the dispatch table (in which there is no
5612 explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer, and instead
5613 the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch table. */
5614
5615 static int
5616 ada_tag_name_2 (struct tag_args *args)
5617 {
5618 struct type *info_type;
5619 static char name[1024];
5620 char *p;
5621 struct value *val, *valp;
5622
5623 args->name = NULL;
5624 info_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
5625 if (info_type == NULL)
5626 return 0;
5627 info_type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (info_type));
5628 valp = value_cast (info_type, args->tag);
5629 if (valp == NULL)
5630 return 0;
5631 val = value_ind (value_ptradd (valp, -1));
5632 if (val == NULL)
5633 return 0;
5634 val = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "expanded_name", 1);
5635 if (val == NULL)
5636 return 0;
5637 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
5638 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
5639 if (isalpha (*p))
5640 *p = tolower (*p);
5641 args->name = name;
5642 return 0;
5643 }
5644
5645 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
5646 * a C string. */
5647
5648 const char *
5649 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
5650 {
5651 struct tag_args args;
5652 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
5653 return NULL;
5654 args.tag = tag;
5655 args.name = NULL;
5656 catch_errors (ada_tag_name_1, &args, NULL, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5657 return args.name;
5658 }
5659
5660 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
5661
5662 struct type *
5663 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
5664 {
5665 int i;
5666
5667 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
5668
5669 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
5670 return NULL;
5671
5672 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
5673 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
5674 {
5675 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
5676
5677 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */
5678 if (TYPE_CODE (parent_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5679 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type);
5680 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */
5681 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type);
5682
5683 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type);
5684 }
5685
5686 return NULL;
5687 }
5688
5689 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
5690 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
5691 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
5692
5693 int
5694 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5695 {
5696 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
5697 return (name != NULL
5698 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
5699 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0));
5700 }
5701
5702 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
5703 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
5704 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
5705 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
5706 structures. */
5707
5708 int
5709 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5710 {
5711 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5712 return (name != NULL
5713 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
5714 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
5715 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0
5716 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
5717 }
5718
5719 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
5720 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
5721 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
5722
5723 int
5724 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
5725 {
5726 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
5727 return (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
5728 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
5729 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type))
5730 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
5731 }
5732
5733 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
5734 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
5735 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant.
5736 May return NULL if the type could not be found. */
5737
5738 struct type *
5739 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
5740 {
5741 char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
5742 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1, NULL);
5743 }
5744
5745 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
5746 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
5747 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
5748
5749 int
5750 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
5751 {
5752 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5753 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
5754 }
5755
5756 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
5757 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
5758 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
5759
5760 char *
5761 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
5762 {
5763 static char *result = NULL;
5764 static size_t result_len = 0;
5765 struct type *type;
5766 const char *name;
5767 const char *discrim_end;
5768 const char *discrim_start;
5769
5770 if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5771 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
5772 else
5773 type = type0;
5774
5775 name = ada_type_name (type);
5776
5777 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
5778 return "";
5779
5780 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
5781 discrim_end -= 1)
5782 {
5783 if (strncmp (discrim_end, "___XVN", 6) == 0)
5784 break;
5785 }
5786 if (discrim_end == name)
5787 return "";
5788
5789 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
5790 discrim_start -= 1)
5791 {
5792 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
5793 return "";
5794 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
5795 && strncmp (discrim_start - 3, "___", 3) == 0)
5796 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
5797 break;
5798 }
5799
5800 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
5801 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
5802 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
5803 return result;
5804 }
5805
5806 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
5807 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
5808 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
5809 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
5810 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
5811 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
5812 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
5813
5814 int
5815 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
5816 {
5817 ULONGEST RU;
5818
5819 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
5820 return 0;
5821
5822 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
5823 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
5824 LONGEST. */
5825 RU = 0;
5826 while (isdigit (str[k]))
5827 {
5828 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
5829 k += 1;
5830 }
5831
5832 if (str[k] == 'm')
5833 {
5834 if (R != NULL)
5835 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
5836 k += 1;
5837 }
5838 else if (R != NULL)
5839 *R = (LONGEST) RU;
5840
5841 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
5842 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
5843 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
5844 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
5845 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
5846
5847 if (new_k != NULL)
5848 *new_k = k;
5849 return 1;
5850 }
5851
5852 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
5853 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
5854 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
5855
5856 int
5857 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
5858 {
5859 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5860 int p;
5861
5862 p = 0;
5863 while (1)
5864 {
5865 switch (name[p])
5866 {
5867 case '\0':
5868 return 0;
5869 case 'S':
5870 {
5871 LONGEST W;
5872 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
5873 return 0;
5874 if (val == W)
5875 return 1;
5876 break;
5877 }
5878 case 'R':
5879 {
5880 LONGEST L, U;
5881 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
5882 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
5883 return 0;
5884 if (val >= L && val <= U)
5885 return 1;
5886 break;
5887 }
5888 case 'O':
5889 return 1;
5890 default:
5891 return 0;
5892 }
5893 }
5894 }
5895
5896 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
5897
5898 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
5899 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
5900 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
5901 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
5902
5903 static struct value *
5904 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
5905 struct type *arg_type)
5906 {
5907 struct type *type;
5908
5909 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
5910 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
5911
5912 /* Handle packed fields. */
5913
5914 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0)
5915 {
5916 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
5917 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
5918
5919 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
5920 offset + bit_pos / 8,
5921 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
5922 }
5923 else
5924 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
5925 }
5926
5927 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
5928 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
5929 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
5930 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
5931 an object of that type;
5932 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
5933 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
5934 0 otherwise;
5935 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
5936 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
5937 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
5938 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
5939
5940 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
5941
5942 static int
5943 find_struct_field (char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
5944 struct type **field_type_p,
5945 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
5946 int *index_p)
5947 {
5948 int i;
5949
5950 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
5951
5952 if (field_type_p != NULL)
5953 *field_type_p = NULL;
5954 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
5955 *byte_offset_p = 0;
5956 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
5957 *bit_offset_p = 0;
5958 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
5959 *bit_size_p = 0;
5960
5961 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
5962 {
5963 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
5964 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
5965 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
5966
5967 if (t_field_name == NULL)
5968 continue;
5969
5970 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
5971 {
5972 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
5973 if (field_type_p != NULL)
5974 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
5975 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
5976 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
5977 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
5978 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
5979 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
5980 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
5981 return 1;
5982 }
5983 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
5984 {
5985 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
5986 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
5987 bit_size_p, index_p))
5988 return 1;
5989 }
5990 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
5991 {
5992 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
5993 fixed type?? */
5994 int j;
5995 struct type *field_type
5996 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
5997
5998 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
5999 {
6000 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
6001 fld_offset
6002 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6003 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
6004 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
6005 return 1;
6006 }
6007 }
6008 else if (index_p != NULL)
6009 *index_p += 1;
6010 }
6011 return 0;
6012 }
6013
6014 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
6015
6016 static int
6017 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
6018 {
6019 int n;
6020 n = 0;
6021 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
6022 return n;
6023 }
6024
6025 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
6026 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6027 If found, return value, else return NULL.
6028
6029 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent'). */
6030
6031 static struct value *
6032 ada_search_struct_field (char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
6033 struct type *type)
6034 {
6035 int i;
6036 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6037
6038 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6039 {
6040 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6041
6042 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6043 continue;
6044
6045 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6046 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6047
6048 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6049 {
6050 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6051 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
6052 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6053 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6054 if (v != NULL)
6055 return v;
6056 }
6057
6058 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6059 {
6060 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
6061 int j;
6062 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6063 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6064
6065 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6066 {
6067 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line break. */
6068 (name, arg,
6069 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6070 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6071 if (v != NULL)
6072 return v;
6073 }
6074 }
6075 }
6076 return NULL;
6077 }
6078
6079 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
6080 int, struct type *);
6081
6082
6083 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
6084 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
6085 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6086 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
6087
6088 static struct value *
6089 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
6090 struct type *type)
6091 {
6092 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
6093 }
6094
6095
6096 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
6097 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
6098 * *INDEX_P. */
6099
6100 static struct value *
6101 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
6102 struct type *type)
6103 {
6104 int i;
6105 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6106
6107 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6108 {
6109 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
6110 continue;
6111 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6112 {
6113 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6114 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
6115 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6116 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6117 if (v != NULL)
6118 return v;
6119 }
6120
6121 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6122 {
6123 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
6124 find_struct_field. */
6125 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
6126 }
6127 else if (*index_p == 0)
6128 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6129 else
6130 *index_p -= 1;
6131 }
6132 return NULL;
6133 }
6134
6135 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
6136 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
6137 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
6138 appropriate type.
6139
6140 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
6141 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
6142 (e.g., '_parent').
6143
6144 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
6145 calling error. */
6146
6147 struct value *
6148 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, char *name, int no_err)
6149 {
6150 struct type *t, *t1;
6151 struct value *v;
6152
6153 v = NULL;
6154 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
6155 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6156 {
6157 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6158 if (t1 == NULL)
6159 goto BadValue;
6160 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6161 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6162 {
6163 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
6164 t = t1;
6165 }
6166 }
6167
6168 while (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6169 {
6170 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6171 if (t1 == NULL)
6172 goto BadValue;
6173 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6174 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6175 {
6176 arg = value_ind (arg);
6177 t = t1;
6178 }
6179 else
6180 break;
6181 }
6182
6183 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
6184 goto BadValue;
6185
6186 if (t1 == t)
6187 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
6188 else
6189 {
6190 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
6191 struct type *field_type;
6192 CORE_ADDR address;
6193
6194 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6195 address = value_as_address (arg);
6196 else
6197 address = unpack_pointer (t, value_contents (arg));
6198
6199 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL, address, NULL, 1);
6200 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
6201 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
6202 &bit_size, NULL))
6203 {
6204 if (bit_size != 0)
6205 {
6206 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6207 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
6208 else
6209 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
6210 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
6211 bit_offset, bit_size,
6212 field_type);
6213 }
6214 else
6215 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset);
6216 }
6217 }
6218
6219 if (v != NULL || no_err)
6220 return v;
6221 else
6222 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
6223
6224 BadValue:
6225 if (no_err)
6226 return NULL;
6227 else
6228 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of a value that is not a record."));
6229 }
6230
6231 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
6232 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
6233 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
6234 work for packed fields).
6235
6236 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
6237 followed by "___".
6238
6239 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
6240 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
6241 ultimate target type will be searched.
6242
6243 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
6244
6245 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
6246 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
6247
6248 static struct type *
6249 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, char *name, int refok,
6250 int noerr, int *dispp)
6251 {
6252 int i;
6253
6254 if (name == NULL)
6255 goto BadName;
6256
6257 if (refok && type != NULL)
6258 while (1)
6259 {
6260 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6261 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
6262 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
6263 break;
6264 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
6265 }
6266
6267 if (type == NULL
6268 || (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
6269 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
6270 {
6271 if (noerr)
6272 return NULL;
6273 else
6274 {
6275 target_terminal_ours ();
6276 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6277 if (type == NULL)
6278 error (_("Type (null) is not a structure or union type"));
6279 else
6280 {
6281 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6282 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6283 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6284 error (_(" is not a structure or union type"));
6285 }
6286 }
6287 }
6288
6289 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
6290
6291 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6292 {
6293 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6294 struct type *t;
6295 int disp;
6296
6297 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6298 continue;
6299
6300 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6301 {
6302 if (dispp != NULL)
6303 *dispp += TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6304 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6305 }
6306
6307 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6308 {
6309 disp = 0;
6310 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
6311 0, 1, &disp);
6312 if (t != NULL)
6313 {
6314 if (dispp != NULL)
6315 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6316 return t;
6317 }
6318 }
6319
6320 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6321 {
6322 int j;
6323 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6324
6325 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
6326 {
6327 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is
6328 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes
6329 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit
6330 if the compiler changes this practice. */
6331 char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j);
6332 disp = 0;
6333 if (v_field_name != NULL
6334 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name))
6335 t = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6336 else
6337 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
6338 name, 0, 1, &disp);
6339
6340 if (t != NULL)
6341 {
6342 if (dispp != NULL)
6343 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6344 return t;
6345 }
6346 }
6347 }
6348
6349 }
6350
6351 BadName:
6352 if (!noerr)
6353 {
6354 target_terminal_ours ();
6355 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6356 if (name == NULL)
6357 {
6358 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6359 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6360 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6361 error (_(" has no component named <null>"));
6362 }
6363 else
6364 {
6365 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6366 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6367 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6368 error (_(" has no component named %s"), name);
6369 }
6370 }
6371
6372 return NULL;
6373 }
6374
6375 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6376 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE
6377 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a
6378 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */
6379
6380 static int
6381 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6382 {
6383 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6384 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1, NULL)
6385 == NULL);
6386 }
6387
6388
6389 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6390 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE that is stored in GDB at
6391 OUTER_VALADDR, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
6392 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
6393
6394 int
6395 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type,
6396 const gdb_byte *outer_valaddr)
6397 {
6398 int others_clause;
6399 int i;
6400 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6401 struct value *outer;
6402 struct value *discrim;
6403 LONGEST discrim_val;
6404
6405 outer = value_from_contents_and_address (outer_type, outer_valaddr, 0);
6406 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
6407 if (discrim == NULL)
6408 return -1;
6409 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
6410
6411 others_clause = -1;
6412 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1)
6413 {
6414 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
6415 others_clause = i;
6416 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
6417 return i;
6418 }
6419
6420 return others_clause;
6421 }
6422 \f
6423
6424
6425 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
6426
6427 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
6428 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
6429 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
6430 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
6431 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
6432
6433 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
6434 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
6435 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
6436 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
6437 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
6438 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
6439 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
6440 rather than struct value*s.
6441
6442 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
6443 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
6444 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
6445 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
6446 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
6447 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
6448 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
6449 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
6450 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
6451 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
6452 element selected. */
6453
6454 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
6455 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
6456 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
6457 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
6458 target at the target address. */
6459
6460 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
6461 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
6462 dynamic-sized types. */
6463
6464 struct value *
6465 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
6466 {
6467 struct value *val = unwrap_value (value_ind (val0));
6468 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6469 }
6470
6471 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
6472 qualifiers on VAL0. */
6473
6474 static struct value *
6475 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
6476 {
6477 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val0)) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6478 {
6479 struct value *val = val0;
6480 val = coerce_ref (val);
6481 val = unwrap_value (val);
6482 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6483 }
6484 else
6485 return val0;
6486 }
6487
6488 /* Return OFF rounded upward if necessary to a multiple of
6489 ALIGNMENT (a power of 2). */
6490
6491 static unsigned int
6492 align_value (unsigned int off, unsigned int alignment)
6493 {
6494 return (off + alignment - 1) & ~(alignment - 1);
6495 }
6496
6497 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
6498
6499 static unsigned int
6500 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
6501 {
6502 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6503 int len;
6504 int align_offset;
6505
6506 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
6507 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
6508 require any alignment. */
6509 if (name == NULL)
6510 return 1;
6511
6512 len = strlen (name);
6513
6514 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
6515 return 1;
6516
6517 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
6518 align_offset = len - 2;
6519 else
6520 align_offset = len - 1;
6521
6522 if (align_offset < 7 || strncmp ("___XV", name + align_offset - 6, 5) != 0)
6523 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6524
6525 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6526 }
6527
6528 /* Find a symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
6529
6530 struct symbol *
6531 ada_find_any_symbol (const char *name)
6532 {
6533 struct symbol *sym;
6534
6535 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
6536 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
6537 return sym;
6538
6539 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
6540 return sym;
6541 }
6542
6543 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. This routine will look
6544 solely for types defined by debug info, it will not search the GDB
6545 primitive types. */
6546
6547 struct type *
6548 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
6549 {
6550 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_symbol (name);
6551
6552 if (sym != NULL)
6553 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
6554
6555 return NULL;
6556 }
6557
6558 /* Given NAME and an associated BLOCK, search all symbols for
6559 NAME suffixed with "___XR", which is the ``renaming'' symbol
6560 associated to NAME. Return this symbol if found, return
6561 NULL otherwise. */
6562
6563 struct symbol *
6564 ada_find_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
6565 {
6566 struct symbol *sym;
6567
6568 sym = find_old_style_renaming_symbol (name, block);
6569
6570 if (sym != NULL)
6571 return sym;
6572
6573 /* Not right yet. FIXME pnh 7/20/2007. */
6574 sym = ada_find_any_symbol (name);
6575 if (sym != NULL && strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR") != NULL)
6576 return sym;
6577 else
6578 return NULL;
6579 }
6580
6581 static struct symbol *
6582 find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
6583 {
6584 const struct symbol *function_sym = block_linkage_function (block);
6585 char *rename;
6586
6587 if (function_sym != NULL)
6588 {
6589 /* If the symbol is defined inside a function, NAME is not fully
6590 qualified. This means we need to prepend the function name
6591 as well as adding the ``___XR'' suffix to build the name of
6592 the associated renaming symbol. */
6593 char *function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (function_sym);
6594 /* Function names sometimes contain suffixes used
6595 for instance to qualify nested subprograms. When building
6596 the XR type name, we need to make sure that this suffix is
6597 not included. So do not include any suffix in the function
6598 name length below. */
6599 int function_name_len = ada_name_prefix_len (function_name);
6600 const int rename_len = function_name_len + 2 /* "__" */
6601 + strlen (name) + 6 /* "___XR\0" */ ;
6602
6603 /* Strip the suffix if necessary. */
6604 ada_remove_trailing_digits (function_name, &function_name_len);
6605 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
6606 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
6607
6608 /* Library-level functions are a special case, as GNAT adds
6609 a ``_ada_'' prefix to the function name to avoid namespace
6610 pollution. However, the renaming symbols themselves do not
6611 have this prefix, so we need to skip this prefix if present. */
6612 if (function_name_len > 5 /* "_ada_" */
6613 && strstr (function_name, "_ada_") == function_name)
6614 {
6615 function_name += 5;
6616 function_name_len -= 5;
6617 }
6618
6619 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
6620 strncpy (rename, function_name, function_name_len);
6621 xsnprintf (rename + function_name_len, rename_len - function_name_len,
6622 "__%s___XR", name);
6623 }
6624 else
6625 {
6626 const int rename_len = strlen (name) + 6;
6627 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
6628 xsnprintf (rename, rename_len * sizeof (char), "%s___XR", name);
6629 }
6630
6631 return ada_find_any_symbol (rename);
6632 }
6633
6634 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
6635 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
6636 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
6637 otherwise return 0. */
6638
6639 int
6640 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
6641 {
6642 if (type1 == NULL)
6643 return 1;
6644 else if (type0 == NULL)
6645 return 0;
6646 else if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
6647 return 1;
6648 else if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
6649 return 0;
6650 else if (TYPE_NAME (type1) == NULL && TYPE_NAME (type0) != NULL)
6651 return 1;
6652 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0))
6653 return 1;
6654 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
6655 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
6656 return 1;
6657 else
6658 {
6659 const char *type0_name = type_name_no_tag (type0);
6660 const char *type1_name = type_name_no_tag (type1);
6661
6662 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
6663 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
6664 return 1;
6665 }
6666 return 0;
6667 }
6668
6669 /* The name of TYPE, which is either its TYPE_NAME, or, if that is
6670 null, its TYPE_TAG_NAME. Null if TYPE is null. */
6671
6672 char *
6673 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
6674 {
6675 if (type == NULL)
6676 return NULL;
6677 else if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL)
6678 return TYPE_NAME (type);
6679 else
6680 return TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
6681 }
6682
6683 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE whose name is formed by appending
6684 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
6685
6686 struct type *
6687 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
6688 {
6689 static char *name;
6690 static size_t name_len = 0;
6691 int len;
6692 char *typename = ada_type_name (type);
6693
6694 if (typename == NULL)
6695 return NULL;
6696
6697 len = strlen (typename);
6698
6699 GROW_VECT (name, name_len, len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
6700
6701 strcpy (name, typename);
6702 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
6703
6704 return ada_find_any_type (name);
6705 }
6706
6707
6708 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
6709 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
6710
6711 static struct type *
6712 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
6713 {
6714 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6715
6716 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
6717 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
6718 return NULL;
6719 else
6720 {
6721 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
6722 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
6723 return type;
6724 else
6725 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
6726 }
6727 }
6728
6729 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
6730 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
6731
6732 static int
6733 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
6734 {
6735 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
6736 return name != NULL
6737 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
6738 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
6739 }
6740
6741 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
6742 represent a variant record type. */
6743
6744 static int
6745 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
6746 {
6747 int f;
6748
6749 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6750 return -1;
6751
6752 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1)
6753 {
6754 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
6755 return f;
6756 }
6757 return -1;
6758 }
6759
6760 /* A record type with no fields. */
6761
6762 static struct type *
6763 empty_record (struct type *template)
6764 {
6765 struct type *type = alloc_type_copy (template);
6766 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
6767 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = 0;
6768 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL;
6769 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
6770 TYPE_NAME (type) = "<empty>";
6771 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
6772 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
6773 return type;
6774 }
6775
6776 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
6777 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
6778 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
6779 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
6780 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
6781 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
6782 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
6783 of the variant.
6784
6785 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
6786 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
6787 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
6788
6789 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
6790 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
6791 byte-aligned. */
6792
6793 struct type *
6794 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
6795 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6796 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
6797 int keep_dynamic_fields)
6798 {
6799 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
6800 struct value *dval;
6801 struct type *rtype;
6802 int nfields, bit_len;
6803 int variant_field;
6804 long off;
6805 int fld_bit_len, bit_incr;
6806 int f;
6807
6808 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
6809 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
6810 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
6811 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
6812 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
6813 else
6814 {
6815 nfields = 0;
6816 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type)
6817 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
6818 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
6819 nfields++;
6820 }
6821
6822 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
6823 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
6824 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
6825 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
6826 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *)
6827 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
6828 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
6829 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
6830 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
6831 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
6832
6833 off = 0;
6834 bit_len = 0;
6835 variant_field = -1;
6836
6837 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
6838 {
6839 off = align_value (off, field_alignment (type, f))
6840 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
6841 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, f) = off;
6842 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
6843
6844 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
6845 {
6846 variant_field = f;
6847 fld_bit_len = bit_incr = 0;
6848 }
6849 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
6850 {
6851 const gdb_byte *field_valaddr = valaddr;
6852 CORE_ADDR field_address = address;
6853 struct type *field_type =
6854 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f));
6855
6856 if (dval0 == NULL)
6857 {
6858 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time
6859 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not
6860 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and
6861 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the
6862 size first before creating the value. */
6863 check_size (rtype);
6864 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
6865 }
6866 else
6867 dval = dval0;
6868
6869 /* If the type referenced by this field is an aligner type, we need
6870 to unwrap that aligner type, because its size might not be set.
6871 Keeping the aligner type would cause us to compute the wrong
6872 size for this field, impacting the offset of the all the fields
6873 that follow this one. */
6874 if (ada_is_aligner_type (field_type))
6875 {
6876 long field_offset = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, f);
6877
6878 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, field_offset);
6879 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, field_offset);
6880 field_type = ada_aligned_type (field_type);
6881 }
6882
6883 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr,
6884 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
6885 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address,
6886 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
6887
6888 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case,
6889 we do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if
6890 the current field is the parent part of a tagged record,
6891 we will get the tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real
6892 type of the parent is not the real type of the child. We
6893 would end up in an infinite loop. */
6894 field_type = ada_get_base_type (field_type);
6895 field_type = ada_to_fixed_type (field_type, field_valaddr,
6896 field_address, dval, 0);
6897
6898 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type;
6899 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6900 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
6901 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6902 }
6903 else
6904 {
6905 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
6906 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6907 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
6908 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
6909 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
6910 else
6911 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
6912 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6913 }
6914 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
6915 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
6916 off += bit_incr;
6917 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
6918 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6919 }
6920
6921 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
6922 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of
6923 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
6924 clauses. */
6925 if (variant_field >= 0)
6926 {
6927 struct type *branch_type;
6928
6929 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
6930
6931 if (dval0 == NULL)
6932 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
6933 else
6934 dval = dval0;
6935
6936 branch_type =
6937 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
6938 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
6939 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
6940 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
6941 if (branch_type == NULL)
6942 {
6943 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1)
6944 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
6945 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
6946 }
6947 else
6948 {
6949 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
6950 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
6951 fld_bit_len =
6952 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
6953 TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6954 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
6955 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
6956 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
6957 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6958 }
6959 }
6960
6961 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
6962 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
6963 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
6964 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
6965 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
6966 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
6967 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
6968 {
6969 if (TYPE_NAME (rtype))
6970 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %d."),
6971 TYPE_NAME (rtype), TYPE_LENGTH (type));
6972 else
6973 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %d."),
6974 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
6975 }
6976 else
6977 {
6978 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_value (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
6979 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
6980 }
6981
6982 value_free_to_mark (mark);
6983 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
6984 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
6985 return rtype;
6986 }
6987
6988 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
6989 of 1. */
6990
6991 static struct type *
6992 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6993 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
6994 {
6995 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
6996 address, dval0, 1);
6997 }
6998
6999 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
7000 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
7001 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
7002 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
7003 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
7004 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
7005 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
7006 template type. */
7007
7008 static struct type *
7009 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
7010 {
7011 struct type *type;
7012 int nfields;
7013 int f;
7014
7015 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
7016 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
7017
7018 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0);
7019 type = type0;
7020
7021 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
7022 {
7023 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f));
7024 struct type *new_type;
7025
7026 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
7027 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
7028 else
7029 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
7030 if (type == type0 && new_type != field_type)
7031 {
7032 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type_copy (type0);
7033 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE (type0);
7034 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7035 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = nfields;
7036 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *)
7037 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7038 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0),
7039 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7040 TYPE_NAME (type) = ada_type_name (type0);
7041 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7042 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1;
7043 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7044 }
7045 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
7046 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
7047 }
7048 return type;
7049 }
7050
7051 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
7052 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE,
7053 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant
7054 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
7055 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
7056 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
7057
7058 static struct type *
7059 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7060 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7061 {
7062 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7063 struct value *dval;
7064 struct type *rtype;
7065 struct type *branch_type;
7066 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
7067 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
7068
7069 if (variant_field == -1)
7070 return type;
7071
7072 if (dval0 == NULL)
7073 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
7074 else
7075 dval = dval0;
7076
7077 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
7078 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7079 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
7080 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
7081 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) =
7082 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7083 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type),
7084 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7085 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
7086 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
7087 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
7088 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
7089
7090 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7091 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7092 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
7093 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7094 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
7095 cond_offset_target (address,
7096 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7097 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7098 if (branch_type == NULL)
7099 {
7100 int f;
7101 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
7102 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7103 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7104 }
7105 else
7106 {
7107 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7108 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7109 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
7110 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
7111 }
7112 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
7113
7114 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7115 return rtype;
7116 }
7117
7118 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7119 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
7120 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
7121 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
7122 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
7123 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
7124 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
7125 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
7126 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
7127
7128 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
7129 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
7130 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
7131 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
7132 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
7133 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
7134 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
7135
7136 static struct type *
7137 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7138 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7139 {
7140 struct type *templ_type;
7141
7142 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7143 return type0;
7144
7145 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
7146
7147 if (templ_type != NULL)
7148 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
7149 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
7150 {
7151 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
7152 return type0;
7153 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
7154 dval);
7155 }
7156 else
7157 {
7158 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1;
7159 return type0;
7160 }
7161
7162 }
7163
7164 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7165 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
7166 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
7167 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
7168 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
7169 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if
7170 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */
7171
7172 static struct type *
7173 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7174 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7175 {
7176 int which;
7177 struct type *templ_type;
7178 struct type *var_type;
7179
7180 if (TYPE_CODE (var_type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
7181 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
7182 else
7183 var_type = var_type0;
7184
7185 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
7186
7187 if (templ_type != NULL)
7188 var_type = templ_type;
7189
7190 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval)))
7191 return var_type0;
7192 which =
7193 ada_which_variant_applies (var_type,
7194 value_type (dval), value_contents (dval));
7195
7196 if (which < 0)
7197 return empty_record (var_type);
7198 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
7199 return to_fixed_record_type
7200 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
7201 valaddr, address, dval);
7202 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
7203 return
7204 to_fixed_record_type
7205 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
7206 else
7207 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
7208 }
7209
7210 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
7211 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
7212 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
7213 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
7214 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
7215 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
7216 varsize_limit. */
7217
7218 static struct type *
7219 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
7220 int ignore_too_big)
7221 {
7222 struct type *index_type_desc;
7223 struct type *result;
7224 int constrained_packed_array_p;
7225
7226 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7227 return type0;
7228
7229 constrained_packed_array_p = ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
7230 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
7231 type0 = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
7232
7233 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XA");
7234 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
7235 {
7236 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
7237 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7238 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7239 debugging data. */
7240 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7241 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7242 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7243 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7244 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7245 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7246 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7247 consult the object tag. */
7248 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
7249
7250 /* Make sure we always create a new array type when dealing with
7251 packed array types, since we're going to fix-up the array
7252 type length and element bitsize a little further down. */
7253 if (elt_type0 == elt_type && !constrained_packed_array_p)
7254 result = type0;
7255 else
7256 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (type0),
7257 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
7258 }
7259 else
7260 {
7261 int i;
7262 struct type *elt_type0;
7263
7264 elt_type0 = type0;
7265 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1)
7266 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
7267
7268 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7269 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7270 debugging data. */
7271 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7272 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7273 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7274 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7275 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7276 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7277 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7278 consult the object tag. */
7279 result =
7280 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
7281
7282 elt_type0 = type0;
7283 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
7284 {
7285 struct type *range_type =
7286 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_type_desc, i),
7287 dval, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type0));
7288 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (elt_type0),
7289 result, range_type);
7290 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
7291 }
7292 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
7293 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
7294 }
7295
7296 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
7297 {
7298 /* So far, the resulting type has been created as if the original
7299 type was a regular (non-packed) array type. As a result, the
7300 bitsize of the array elements needs to be set again, and the array
7301 length needs to be recomputed based on that bitsize. */
7302 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (result) / TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (result));
7303 int elt_bitsize = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
7304
7305 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (result, 0) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
7306 TYPE_LENGTH (result) = len * elt_bitsize / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
7307 if (TYPE_LENGTH (result) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < len * elt_bitsize)
7308 TYPE_LENGTH (result)++;
7309 }
7310
7311 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1;
7312 return result;
7313 }
7314
7315
7316 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
7317 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
7318 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
7319 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
7320 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
7321
7322 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
7323 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
7324 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
7325 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
7326 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
7327
7328 static struct type *
7329 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7330 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7331 {
7332 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7333 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
7334 {
7335 default:
7336 return type;
7337 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
7338 {
7339 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7340 struct type *fixed_record_type =
7341 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7342 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
7343 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
7344 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
7345 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
7346 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
7347 them). */
7348
7349 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
7350 {
7351 struct type *real_type =
7352 type_from_tag (value_tag_from_contents_and_address
7353 (fixed_record_type,
7354 valaddr,
7355 address));
7356 if (real_type != NULL)
7357 return to_fixed_record_type (real_type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7358 }
7359
7360 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable.
7361 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */
7362 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL)
7363 {
7364 char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type);
7365 char *xvz_name = alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */);
7366 int xvz_found = 0;
7367 LONGEST size;
7368
7369 xsnprintf (xvz_name, strlen (name) + 7, "%s___XVZ", name);
7370 size = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, &xvz_found);
7371 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size)
7372 {
7373 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type);
7374 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size;
7375
7376 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have
7377 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and
7378 apparently it is something that is hard to fix.
7379
7380 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition
7381 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us
7382 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we
7383 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type
7384 definition.
7385
7386 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are
7387 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble
7388 when using this type to create new types targeting it.
7389 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check
7390 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace
7391 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn,
7392 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too.
7393 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size
7394 of the array is computed from the number of elements in
7395 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */
7396 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0;
7397 }
7398 }
7399 return fixed_record_type;
7400 }
7401 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
7402 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
7403 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
7404 if (dval == NULL)
7405 return type;
7406 else
7407 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
7408 }
7409 }
7410
7411 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
7412 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
7413 ada_to_fixed_type_1 would return the type referenced by TYPE. */
7414
7415 struct type *
7416 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7417 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7418
7419 {
7420 struct type *fixed_type =
7421 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
7422
7423 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
7424 && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == fixed_type)
7425 return type;
7426
7427 return fixed_type;
7428 }
7429
7430 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
7431 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
7432
7433 static struct type *
7434 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
7435 {
7436 struct type *type;
7437
7438 if (type0 == NULL)
7439 return NULL;
7440
7441 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7442 return type0;
7443
7444 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
7445
7446 switch (TYPE_CODE (type0))
7447 {
7448 default:
7449 return type0;
7450 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
7451 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
7452 if (type != NULL)
7453 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
7454 else
7455 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
7456 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
7457 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
7458 if (type != NULL)
7459 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
7460 else
7461 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
7462 }
7463 }
7464
7465 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
7466
7467 static struct type *
7468 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
7469 {
7470 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7471 {
7472 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
7473 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
7474 TYPE_NAME (type1) = ada_type_name (type);
7475
7476 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
7477 }
7478 else
7479 {
7480 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
7481 if (raw_real_type == type)
7482 return type;
7483 else
7484 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
7485 }
7486 }
7487
7488 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
7489 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
7490 type Foo;
7491 type FooP is access Foo;
7492 V: FooP;
7493 type Foo is array ...;
7494 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
7495 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
7496 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
7497 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
7498
7499 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
7500 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
7501
7502 struct type *
7503 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
7504 {
7505 if (type == NULL)
7506 return NULL;
7507
7508 CHECK_TYPEDEF (type);
7509 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
7510 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
7511 || TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) == NULL)
7512 return type;
7513 else
7514 {
7515 char *name = TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
7516 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
7517 return (type1 == NULL) ? type : type1;
7518 }
7519 }
7520
7521 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
7522 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
7523 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
7524 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
7525 creation of struct values]. */
7526
7527 static struct value *
7528 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
7529 struct value *val0)
7530 {
7531 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
7532 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
7533 return val0;
7534 else
7535 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
7536 }
7537
7538 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
7539 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
7540 value. */
7541
7542 static struct value *
7543 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
7544 {
7545 return ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val),
7546 value_address (val),
7547 val);
7548 }
7549
7550 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
7551 chosen to approximate the real type of VAL as well as possible, but
7552 without consulting any runtime values. For Ada dynamic-sized
7553 types, therefore, the type of the result is likely to be inaccurate. */
7554
7555 static struct value *
7556 ada_to_static_fixed_value (struct value *val)
7557 {
7558 struct type *type =
7559 to_static_fixed_type (static_unwrap_type (value_type (val)));
7560 if (type == value_type (val))
7561 return val;
7562 else
7563 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (val, type);
7564 }
7565 \f
7566
7567 /* Attributes */
7568
7569 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
7570 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
7571
7572 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
7573 "<?>",
7574
7575 "first",
7576 "last",
7577 "length",
7578 "image",
7579 "max",
7580 "min",
7581 "modulus",
7582 "pos",
7583 "size",
7584 "tag",
7585 "val",
7586 0
7587 };
7588
7589 const char *
7590 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
7591 {
7592 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
7593 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
7594 else
7595 return attribute_names[0];
7596 }
7597
7598 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
7599
7600 static LONGEST
7601 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
7602 {
7603 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg);
7604 struct type *type = value_type (val);
7605
7606 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
7607 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
7608
7609 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
7610 {
7611 int i;
7612 LONGEST v = value_as_long (val);
7613
7614 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7615 {
7616 if (v == TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i))
7617 return i;
7618 }
7619 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
7620 }
7621 else
7622 return value_as_long (val);
7623 }
7624
7625 static struct value *
7626 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7627 {
7628 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg));
7629 }
7630
7631 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
7632
7633 static struct value *
7634 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7635 {
7636 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
7637 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
7638 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
7639 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
7640
7641 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
7642 {
7643 long pos = value_as_long (arg);
7644 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
7645 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
7646 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, pos));
7647 }
7648 else
7649 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg));
7650 }
7651 \f
7652
7653 /* Evaluation */
7654
7655 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
7656 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
7657 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
7658
7659 int
7660 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
7661 {
7662 const char *name;
7663
7664 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
7665 and don't check any further. */
7666 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
7667 return 1;
7668
7669 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
7670 with a known character type name. */
7671 name = ada_type_name (type);
7672 return (name != NULL
7673 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
7674 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
7675 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
7676 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
7677 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
7678 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
7679 }
7680
7681 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
7682
7683 int
7684 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
7685 {
7686 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7687 if (type != NULL
7688 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
7689 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
7690 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
7691 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
7692 {
7693 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
7694
7695 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
7696 }
7697 else
7698 return 0;
7699 }
7700
7701
7702 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
7703 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
7704 distinctive name. */
7705
7706 int
7707 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
7708 {
7709 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7710
7711 /* If we can find a parallel XVS type, then the XVS type should
7712 be used instead of this type. And hence, this is not an aligner
7713 type. */
7714 if (ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
7715 return 0;
7716
7717 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7718 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1
7719 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
7720 }
7721
7722 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
7723 the parallel type. */
7724
7725 struct type *
7726 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
7727 {
7728 struct type *real_type_namer;
7729 struct type *raw_real_type;
7730
7731 if (raw_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (raw_type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
7732 return raw_type;
7733
7734 if (ada_is_aligner_type (raw_type))
7735 /* The encoding specifies that we should always use the aligner type.
7736 So, even if this aligner type has an associated XVS type, we should
7737 simply ignore it.
7738
7739 According to the compiler gurus, an XVS type parallel to an aligner
7740 type may exist because of a stabs limitation. In stabs, aligner
7741 types are empty because the field has a variable-sized type, and
7742 thus cannot actually be used as an aligner type. As a result,
7743 we need the associated parallel XVS type to decode the type.
7744 Since the policy in the compiler is to not change the internal
7745 representation based on the debugging info format, we sometimes
7746 end up having a redundant XVS type parallel to the aligner type. */
7747 return raw_type;
7748
7749 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
7750 if (real_type_namer == NULL
7751 || TYPE_CODE (real_type_namer) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7752 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1)
7753 return raw_type;
7754
7755 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
7756 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
7757 return raw_type;
7758 else
7759 return raw_real_type;
7760 }
7761
7762 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
7763
7764 struct type *
7765 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
7766 {
7767 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7768 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
7769 else
7770 return ada_get_base_type (type);
7771 }
7772
7773
7774 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
7775 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
7776
7777 const gdb_byte *
7778 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
7779 {
7780 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7781 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
7782 valaddr +
7783 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
7784 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
7785 else
7786 return valaddr;
7787 }
7788
7789
7790
7791 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
7792 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
7793 const char *
7794 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
7795 {
7796 static char *result;
7797 static size_t result_len = 0;
7798 char *tmp;
7799
7800 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
7801 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
7802 all the preceeding characters, the unqualified name starts
7803 right after that dot.
7804 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
7805 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
7806 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
7807 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
7808
7809 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
7810 if (tmp != NULL)
7811 name = tmp + 1;
7812 else
7813 {
7814 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
7815 {
7816 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
7817 break;
7818 else
7819 name = tmp + 2;
7820 }
7821 }
7822
7823 if (name[0] == 'Q')
7824 {
7825 int v;
7826 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
7827 {
7828 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
7829 return name;
7830 }
7831 else
7832 return name;
7833
7834 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
7835 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
7836 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", v);
7837 else if (name[1] == 'U')
7838 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
7839 else
7840 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
7841
7842 return result;
7843 }
7844 else
7845 {
7846 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
7847 if (tmp == NULL)
7848 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
7849 if (tmp != NULL)
7850 {
7851 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
7852 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
7853 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
7854 return result;
7855 }
7856
7857 return name;
7858 }
7859 }
7860
7861 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
7862 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
7863 expression. */
7864
7865 static struct value *
7866 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
7867 {
7868 return evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
7869 }
7870
7871 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
7872 value it wraps. */
7873
7874 static struct value *
7875 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
7876 {
7877 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
7878 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7879 {
7880 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
7881 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
7882 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
7883 TYPE_NAME (val_type) = ada_type_name (type);
7884
7885 return unwrap_value (v);
7886 }
7887 else
7888 {
7889 struct type *raw_real_type =
7890 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
7891
7892 if (type == raw_real_type)
7893 return val;
7894
7895 return
7896 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
7897 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
7898 value_address (val),
7899 NULL, 1));
7900 }
7901 }
7902
7903 static struct value *
7904 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7905 {
7906 LONGEST val;
7907
7908 if (type == value_type (arg))
7909 return arg;
7910 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
7911 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type,
7912 ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
7913 value_as_long (arg)));
7914 else
7915 {
7916 DOUBLEST argd = value_as_double (arg);
7917 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type, argd);
7918 }
7919
7920 return value_from_longest (type, val);
7921 }
7922
7923 static struct value *
7924 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7925 {
7926 DOUBLEST val = ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
7927 value_as_long (arg));
7928 return value_from_double (type, val);
7929 }
7930
7931 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
7932 return the converted value. */
7933
7934 static struct value *
7935 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
7936 {
7937 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
7938 if (type == type2)
7939 return val;
7940
7941 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
7942 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7943
7944 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
7945 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
7946 {
7947 val = ada_value_ind (val);
7948 type2 = value_type (val);
7949 }
7950
7951 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
7952 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
7953 {
7954 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type2) != TYPE_LENGTH (type)
7955 || TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
7956 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2)))
7957 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
7958 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
7959 }
7960 return val;
7961 }
7962
7963 static struct value *
7964 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
7965 {
7966 struct value *val;
7967 struct type *type1, *type2;
7968 LONGEST v, v1, v2;
7969
7970 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
7971 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
7972 type1 = base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
7973 type2 = base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
7974
7975 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) != TYPE_CODE_INT
7976 || TYPE_CODE (type2) != TYPE_CODE_INT)
7977 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
7978
7979 switch (op)
7980 {
7981 case BINOP_MOD:
7982 case BINOP_DIV:
7983 case BINOP_REM:
7984 break;
7985 default:
7986 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
7987 }
7988
7989 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
7990 if (v2 == 0)
7991 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
7992
7993 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
7994 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
7995
7996 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
7997 switch (op)
7998 {
7999 case BINOP_DIV:
8000 v = v1 / v2;
8001 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
8002 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
8003 break;
8004 case BINOP_REM:
8005 v = v1 % v2;
8006 if (v * v1 < 0)
8007 v -= v2;
8008 break;
8009 default:
8010 /* Should not reach this point. */
8011 v = 0;
8012 }
8013
8014 val = allocate_value (type1);
8015 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
8016 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)),
8017 gdbarch_byte_order (get_type_arch (type1)), v);
8018 return val;
8019 }
8020
8021 static int
8022 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
8023 {
8024 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
8025 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
8026 {
8027 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
8028 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
8029 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
8030 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
8031
8032 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
8033 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
8034 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8035 || TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8036 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
8037 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
8038 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
8039 and do not have user-defined equality. */
8040 return
8041 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg2))
8042 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
8043 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1))) == 0;
8044 }
8045 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
8046 }
8047
8048 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
8049 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
8050 OP_AGGREGATE. */
8051
8052 static int
8053 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
8054 {
8055 int n, m, i;
8056 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8057 pc += 3;
8058 n = 0;
8059 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
8060 {
8061 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
8062 {
8063 default:
8064 n += 1;
8065 break;
8066 case OP_CHOICES:
8067 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8068 break;
8069 }
8070 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
8071 }
8072 return n;
8073 }
8074
8075 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
8076 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
8077 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
8078 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
8079 LHS == CONTAINER). */
8080
8081 static void
8082 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
8083 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
8084 {
8085 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8086 struct value *elt;
8087 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (lhs)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8088 {
8089 struct type *index_type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
8090 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (index_type, index);
8091 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
8092 }
8093 else
8094 {
8095 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
8096 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (unwrap_value (elt));
8097 }
8098
8099 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
8100 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
8101 else
8102 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
8103 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8104 EVAL_NORMAL));
8105
8106 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8107 }
8108
8109 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
8110 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
8111 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
8112 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
8113 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
8114 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
8115 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
8116
8117 static struct value *
8118 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
8119 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8120 int *pos, enum noside noside)
8121 {
8122 struct type *lhs_type;
8123 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
8124 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
8125 int num_specs;
8126 LONGEST *indices;
8127 int max_indices, num_indices;
8128 int is_array_aggregate;
8129 int i;
8130 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8131
8132 *pos += 3;
8133 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
8134 {
8135 int i;
8136 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8137 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
8138 return container;
8139 }
8140
8141 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
8142 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
8143 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
8144 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
8145 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
8146 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
8147
8148 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8149 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
8150 {
8151 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
8152 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8153 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8154 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8155 is_array_aggregate = 1;
8156 }
8157 else if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8158 {
8159 low_index = 0;
8160 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
8161 is_array_aggregate = 0;
8162 }
8163 else
8164 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
8165
8166 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
8167 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
8168 indices = alloca (max_indices * sizeof (indices[0]));
8169 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
8170 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
8171 num_indices = 4;
8172
8173 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8174 {
8175 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
8176 {
8177 case OP_CHOICES:
8178 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8179 &num_indices, max_indices,
8180 low_index, high_index);
8181 break;
8182 case OP_POSITIONAL:
8183 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8184 &num_indices, max_indices,
8185 low_index, high_index);
8186 break;
8187 case OP_OTHERS:
8188 if (i != n-1)
8189 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
8190 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8191 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
8192 break;
8193 default:
8194 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
8195 }
8196 }
8197
8198 return container;
8199 }
8200
8201 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
8202 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8203 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
8204 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
8205 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
8206 assign_aggregate. */
8207 static void
8208 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
8209 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8210 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8211 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8212 {
8213 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
8214
8215 if (ind - 1 == high)
8216 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
8217 if (ind <= high)
8218 {
8219 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
8220 *pos += 3;
8221 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
8222 }
8223 else
8224 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8225 }
8226
8227 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
8228 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8229 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
8230 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
8231 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
8232 static void
8233 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
8234 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8235 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8236 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8237 {
8238 int j;
8239 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
8240 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
8241 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
8242
8243 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
8244
8245 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8246 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8247 expr_pc = *pos;
8248 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8249
8250 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8251 {
8252 LONGEST lower, upper;
8253 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
8254 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
8255 {
8256 choice_pos += 1;
8257 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8258 EVAL_NORMAL));
8259 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8260 EVAL_NORMAL));
8261 }
8262 else if (is_array)
8263 {
8264 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
8265 EVAL_NORMAL));
8266 upper = lower;
8267 }
8268 else
8269 {
8270 int ind;
8271 char *name;
8272 switch (op)
8273 {
8274 case OP_NAME:
8275 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
8276 break;
8277 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8278 name = SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol);
8279 break;
8280 default:
8281 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
8282 }
8283 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8284 ind = 0;
8285 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
8286 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
8287 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
8288 lower = upper = ind;
8289 }
8290
8291 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
8292 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
8293
8294 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
8295 max_indices);
8296 while (lower <= upper)
8297 {
8298 int pos1;
8299 pos1 = expr_pc;
8300 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
8301 lower += 1;
8302 }
8303 }
8304 }
8305
8306 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
8307 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
8308 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
8309 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
8310 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate*/
8311 static void
8312 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
8313 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8314 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
8315 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8316 {
8317 int i;
8318 int expr_pc = *pos+1;
8319
8320 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
8321 {
8322 LONGEST ind;
8323 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
8324 {
8325 int pos;
8326 pos = expr_pc;
8327 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &pos);
8328 }
8329 }
8330 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8331 }
8332
8333 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
8334 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
8335 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
8336 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
8337 static void
8338 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
8339 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
8340 {
8341 int i, j;
8342 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
8343 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
8344 {
8345 int kh;
8346 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
8347 if (high < indices[kh])
8348 break;
8349 if (low < indices[i])
8350 indices[i] = low;
8351 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
8352 if (high > indices[i + 1])
8353 indices[i + 1] = high;
8354 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
8355 *size -= kh - i - 2;
8356 return;
8357 }
8358 else if (high < indices[i])
8359 break;
8360 }
8361
8362 if (*size == max_size)
8363 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
8364 *size += 2;
8365 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
8366 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
8367 indices[i] = low;
8368 indices[i + 1] = high;
8369 }
8370
8371 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
8372 is different. */
8373
8374 static struct value *
8375 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2, enum noside noside)
8376 {
8377 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
8378 return arg2;
8379
8380 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (type))
8381 return (cast_to_fixed (type, arg2));
8382
8383 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8384 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
8385
8386 return value_cast (type, arg2);
8387 }
8388
8389 /* Evaluating Ada expressions, and printing their result.
8390 ------------------------------------------------------
8391
8392 1. Introduction:
8393 ----------------
8394
8395 We usually evaluate an Ada expression in order to print its value.
8396 We also evaluate an expression in order to print its type, which
8397 happens during the EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase of the evaluation,
8398 but we'll focus mostly on the EVAL_NORMAL phase. In practice, the
8399 EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase allows us to simplify certain aspects of
8400 the evaluation compared to the EVAL_NORMAL, but is otherwise very
8401 similar.
8402
8403 Evaluating expressions is a little more complicated for Ada entities
8404 than it is for entities in languages such as C. The main reason for
8405 this is that Ada provides types whose definition might be dynamic.
8406 One example of such types is variant records. Or another example
8407 would be an array whose bounds can only be known at run time.
8408
8409 The following description is a general guide as to what should be
8410 done (and what should NOT be done) in order to evaluate an expression
8411 involving such types, and when. This does not cover how the semantic
8412 information is encoded by GNAT as this is covered separatly. For the
8413 document used as the reference for the GNAT encoding, see exp_dbug.ads
8414 in the GNAT sources.
8415
8416 Ideally, we should embed each part of this description next to its
8417 associated code. Unfortunately, the amount of code is so vast right
8418 now that it's hard to see whether the code handling a particular
8419 situation might be duplicated or not. One day, when the code is
8420 cleaned up, this guide might become redundant with the comments
8421 inserted in the code, and we might want to remove it.
8422
8423 2. ``Fixing'' an Entity, the Simple Case:
8424 -----------------------------------------
8425
8426 When evaluating Ada expressions, the tricky issue is that they may
8427 reference entities whose type contents and size are not statically
8428 known. Consider for instance a variant record:
8429
8430 type Rec (Empty : Boolean := True) is record
8431 case Empty is
8432 when True => null;
8433 when False => Value : Integer;
8434 end case;
8435 end record;
8436 Yes : Rec := (Empty => False, Value => 1);
8437 No : Rec := (empty => True);
8438
8439 The size and contents of that record depends on the value of the
8440 descriminant (Rec.Empty). At this point, neither the debugging
8441 information nor the associated type structure in GDB are able to
8442 express such dynamic types. So what the debugger does is to create
8443 "fixed" versions of the type that applies to the specific object.
8444 We also informally refer to this opperation as "fixing" an object,
8445 which means creating its associated fixed type.
8446
8447 Example: when printing the value of variable "Yes" above, its fixed
8448 type would look like this:
8449
8450 type Rec is record
8451 Empty : Boolean;
8452 Value : Integer;
8453 end record;
8454
8455 On the other hand, if we printed the value of "No", its fixed type
8456 would become:
8457
8458 type Rec is record
8459 Empty : Boolean;
8460 end record;
8461
8462 Things become a little more complicated when trying to fix an entity
8463 with a dynamic type that directly contains another dynamic type,
8464 such as an array of variant records, for instance. There are
8465 two possible cases: Arrays, and records.
8466
8467 3. ``Fixing'' Arrays:
8468 ---------------------
8469
8470 The type structure in GDB describes an array in terms of its bounds,
8471 and the type of its elements. By design, all elements in the array
8472 have the same type and we cannot represent an array of variant elements
8473 using the current type structure in GDB. When fixing an array,
8474 we cannot fix the array element, as we would potentially need one
8475 fixed type per element of the array. As a result, the best we can do
8476 when fixing an array is to produce an array whose bounds and size
8477 are correct (allowing us to read it from memory), but without having
8478 touched its element type. Fixing each element will be done later,
8479 when (if) necessary.
8480
8481 Arrays are a little simpler to handle than records, because the same
8482 amount of memory is allocated for each element of the array, even if
8483 the amount of space actually used by each element differs from element
8484 to element. Consider for instance the following array of type Rec:
8485
8486 type Rec_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Rec;
8487
8488 The actual amount of memory occupied by each element might be different
8489 from element to element, depending on the value of their discriminant.
8490 But the amount of space reserved for each element in the array remains
8491 fixed regardless. So we simply need to compute that size using
8492 the debugging information available, from which we can then determine
8493 the array size (we multiply the number of elements of the array by
8494 the size of each element).
8495
8496 The simplest case is when we have an array of a constrained element
8497 type. For instance, consider the following type declarations:
8498
8499 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Integer) is
8500 Length : Integer;
8501 Buffer : String (1 .. Max_Size);
8502 end record;
8503 type Bounded_String_Array is array (1 ..2) of Bounded_String (80);
8504
8505 In this case, the compiler describes the array as an array of
8506 variable-size elements (identified by its XVS suffix) for which
8507 the size can be read in the parallel XVZ variable.
8508
8509 In the case of an array of an unconstrained element type, the compiler
8510 wraps the array element inside a private PAD type. This type should not
8511 be shown to the user, and must be "unwrap"'ed before printing. Note
8512 that we also use the adjective "aligner" in our code to designate
8513 these wrapper types.
8514
8515 In some cases, the size allocated for each element is statically
8516 known. In that case, the PAD type already has the correct size,
8517 and the array element should remain unfixed.
8518
8519 But there are cases when this size is not statically known.
8520 For instance, assuming that "Five" is an integer variable:
8521
8522 type Dynamic is array (1 .. Five) of Integer;
8523 type Wrapper (Has_Length : Boolean := False) is record
8524 Data : Dynamic;
8525 case Has_Length is
8526 when True => Length : Integer;
8527 when False => null;
8528 end case;
8529 end record;
8530 type Wrapper_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Wrapper;
8531
8532 Hello : Wrapper_Array := (others => (Has_Length => True,
8533 Data => (others => 17),
8534 Length => 1));
8535
8536
8537 The debugging info would describe variable Hello as being an
8538 array of a PAD type. The size of that PAD type is not statically
8539 known, but can be determined using a parallel XVZ variable.
8540 In that case, a copy of the PAD type with the correct size should
8541 be used for the fixed array.
8542
8543 3. ``Fixing'' record type objects:
8544 ----------------------------------
8545
8546 Things are slightly different from arrays in the case of dynamic
8547 record types. In this case, in order to compute the associated
8548 fixed type, we need to determine the size and offset of each of
8549 its components. This, in turn, requires us to compute the fixed
8550 type of each of these components.
8551
8552 Consider for instance the example:
8553
8554 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Natural) is record
8555 Str : String (1 .. Max_Size);
8556 Length : Natural;
8557 end record;
8558 My_String : Bounded_String (Max_Size => 10);
8559
8560 In that case, the position of field "Length" depends on the size
8561 of field Str, which itself depends on the value of the Max_Size
8562 discriminant. In order to fix the type of variable My_String,
8563 we need to fix the type of field Str. Therefore, fixing a variant
8564 record requires us to fix each of its components.
8565
8566 However, if a component does not have a dynamic size, the component
8567 should not be fixed. In particular, fields that use a PAD type
8568 should not fixed. Here is an example where this might happen
8569 (assuming type Rec above):
8570
8571 type Container (Big : Boolean) is record
8572 First : Rec;
8573 After : Integer;
8574 case Big is
8575 when True => Another : Integer;
8576 when False => null;
8577 end case;
8578 end record;
8579 My_Container : Container := (Big => False,
8580 First => (Empty => True),
8581 After => 42);
8582
8583 In that example, the compiler creates a PAD type for component First,
8584 whose size is constant, and then positions the component After just
8585 right after it. The offset of component After is therefore constant
8586 in this case.
8587
8588 The debugger computes the position of each field based on an algorithm
8589 that uses, among other things, the actual position and size of the field
8590 preceding it. Let's now imagine that the user is trying to print
8591 the value of My_Container. If the type fixing was recursive, we would
8592 end up computing the offset of field After based on the size of the
8593 fixed version of field First. And since in our example First has
8594 only one actual field, the size of the fixed type is actually smaller
8595 than the amount of space allocated to that field, and thus we would
8596 compute the wrong offset of field After.
8597
8598 To make things more complicated, we need to watch out for dynamic
8599 components of variant records (identified by the ___XVL suffix in
8600 the component name). Even if the target type is a PAD type, the size
8601 of that type might not be statically known. So the PAD type needs
8602 to be unwrapped and the resulting type needs to be fixed. Otherwise,
8603 we might end up with the wrong size for our component. This can be
8604 observed with the following type declarations:
8605
8606 type Octal is new Integer range 0 .. 7;
8607 type Octal_Array is array (Positive range <>) of Octal;
8608 pragma Pack (Octal_Array);
8609
8610 type Octal_Buffer (Size : Positive) is record
8611 Buffer : Octal_Array (1 .. Size);
8612 Length : Integer;
8613 end record;
8614
8615 In that case, Buffer is a PAD type whose size is unset and needs
8616 to be computed by fixing the unwrapped type.
8617
8618 4. When to ``Fix'' un-``Fixed'' sub-elements of an entity:
8619 ----------------------------------------------------------
8620
8621 Lastly, when should the sub-elements of an entity that remained unfixed
8622 thus far, be actually fixed?
8623
8624 The answer is: Only when referencing that element. For instance
8625 when selecting one component of a record, this specific component
8626 should be fixed at that point in time. Or when printing the value
8627 of a record, each component should be fixed before its value gets
8628 printed. Similarly for arrays, the element of the array should be
8629 fixed when printing each element of the array, or when extracting
8630 one element out of that array. On the other hand, fixing should
8631 not be performed on the elements when taking a slice of an array!
8632
8633 Note that one of the side-effects of miscomputing the offset and
8634 size of each field is that we end up also miscomputing the size
8635 of the containing type. This can have adverse results when computing
8636 the value of an entity. GDB fetches the value of an entity based
8637 on the size of its type, and thus a wrong size causes GDB to fetch
8638 the wrong amount of memory. In the case where the computed size is
8639 too small, GDB fetches too little data to print the value of our
8640 entiry. Results in this case as unpredicatble, as we usually read
8641 past the buffer containing the data =:-o. */
8642
8643 /* Implement the evaluate_exp routine in the exp_descriptor structure
8644 for the Ada language. */
8645
8646 static struct value *
8647 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
8648 int *pos, enum noside noside)
8649 {
8650 enum exp_opcode op;
8651 int tem, tem2, tem3;
8652 int pc;
8653 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
8654 struct type *type;
8655 int nargs, oplen;
8656 struct value **argvec;
8657
8658 pc = *pos;
8659 *pos += 1;
8660 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
8661
8662 switch (op)
8663 {
8664 default:
8665 *pos -= 1;
8666 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8667 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
8668
8669 /* If evaluating an OP_DOUBLE and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
8670 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
8671 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
8672 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
8673 types in Ada have different representations.
8674
8675 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
8676 ourselves. */
8677 if ((op == OP_DOUBLE || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
8678 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1, noside);
8679
8680 return arg1;
8681
8682 case OP_STRING:
8683 {
8684 struct value *result;
8685 *pos -= 1;
8686 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8687 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
8688 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
8689 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
8690 TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) = TYPE_CODE_ARRAY;
8691 return result;
8692 }
8693
8694 case UNOP_CAST:
8695 (*pos) += 2;
8696 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
8697 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8698 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8699 goto nosideret;
8700 arg1 = ada_value_cast (type, arg1, noside);
8701 return arg1;
8702
8703 case UNOP_QUAL:
8704 (*pos) += 2;
8705 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
8706 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8707
8708 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
8709 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8710 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
8711 {
8712 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
8713 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8714 return arg1;
8715 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
8716 }
8717 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
8718 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
8719 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
8720 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
8721 type = value_type (arg1);
8722 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
8723 type = NULL;
8724 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8725 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8726 return arg1;
8727 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8728 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
8729 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8730 error
8731 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
8732 else
8733 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
8734 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
8735
8736 case BINOP_ADD:
8737 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8738 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8739 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8740 goto nosideret;
8741 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8742 return (value_from_longest
8743 (value_type (arg1),
8744 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
8745 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
8746 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8747 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
8748 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
8749 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
8750 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
8751 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
8752 type = value_type (arg1);
8753 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
8754 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
8755 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8756 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD));
8757
8758 case BINOP_SUB:
8759 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8760 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8761 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8762 goto nosideret;
8763 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8764 return (value_from_longest
8765 (value_type (arg1),
8766 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
8767 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
8768 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8769 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
8770 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction must have the same type"));
8771 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
8772 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
8773 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
8774 type = value_type (arg1);
8775 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
8776 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
8777 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8778 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB));
8779
8780 case BINOP_MUL:
8781 case BINOP_DIV:
8782 case BINOP_REM:
8783 case BINOP_MOD:
8784 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8785 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8786 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8787 goto nosideret;
8788 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8789 {
8790 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8791 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
8792 }
8793 else
8794 {
8795 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double;
8796 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8797 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1);
8798 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8799 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
8800 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8801 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8802 }
8803
8804 case BINOP_EQUAL:
8805 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
8806 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8807 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
8808 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8809 goto nosideret;
8810 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8811 tem = 0;
8812 else
8813 {
8814 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
8815 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
8816 }
8817 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
8818 tem = !tem;
8819 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8820 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem);
8821
8822 case UNOP_NEG:
8823 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8824 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8825 goto nosideret;
8826 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8827 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
8828 else
8829 {
8830 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
8831 return value_neg (arg1);
8832 }
8833
8834 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
8835 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
8836 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
8837 {
8838 struct value *val;
8839
8840 *pos -= 1;
8841 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8842 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
8843 return value_cast (type, val);
8844 }
8845
8846 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
8847 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
8848 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
8849 {
8850 struct value *val;
8851
8852 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
8853 *pos = pc;
8854 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8855
8856 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
8857 }
8858
8859 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8860 *pos -= 1;
8861
8862 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8863 {
8864 *pos += 4;
8865 goto nosideret;
8866 }
8867 else if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
8868 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
8869 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
8870 invalid. */
8871 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
8872 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
8873 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8874 {
8875 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
8876 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0))
8877 {
8878 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real
8879 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the
8880 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's
8881 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object
8882 type from its tag.
8883
8884 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract
8885 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase
8886 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones.
8887 This can cause problems when trying to print the type
8888 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size:
8889 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order
8890 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description.
8891 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into
8892 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name,
8893 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor
8894 type in the type description. */
8895 struct type *actual_type;
8896
8897 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
8898 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1));
8899 if (actual_type == NULL)
8900 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine
8901 the actual type from the tag, then use the static
8902 approximation that we just computed as a fallback.
8903 This can happen if the debugging information is
8904 incomplete, for instance. */
8905 actual_type = type;
8906
8907 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval);
8908 }
8909
8910 *pos += 4;
8911 return value_zero
8912 (to_static_fixed_type
8913 (static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))),
8914 not_lval);
8915 }
8916 else
8917 {
8918 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8919 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
8920 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
8921 }
8922
8923 case OP_FUNCALL:
8924 (*pos) += 2;
8925
8926 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
8927 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
8928 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
8929 argvec =
8930 (struct value **) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 2));
8931
8932 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
8933 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
8934 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
8935 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
8936 else
8937 {
8938 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
8939 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8940 argvec[tem] = 0;
8941
8942 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8943 goto nosideret;
8944 }
8945
8946 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type
8947 (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
8948 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
8949 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8950 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (value_type (argvec[0]), 0) != 0)
8951 /* This is a packed array that has already been fixed, and
8952 therefore already coerced to a simple array. Nothing further
8953 to do. */
8954 ;
8955 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_REF
8956 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8957 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory))
8958 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
8959
8960 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
8961 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8962 {
8963 switch (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))))
8964 {
8965 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
8966 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8967 break;
8968 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8969 break;
8970 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8971 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8972 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
8973 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8974 break;
8975 default:
8976 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
8977 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
8978 break;
8979 }
8980 }
8981
8982 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
8983 {
8984 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
8985 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8986 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8987 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
8988 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8989 {
8990 int arity;
8991
8992 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
8993 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
8994 if (type == NULL)
8995 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
8996 if (arity != nargs)
8997 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
8998 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8999 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9000 return
9001 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
9002 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
9003 }
9004 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
9005 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9006 {
9007 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
9008 if (type == NULL)
9009 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
9010 else
9011 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9012 }
9013 return
9014 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
9015 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
9016 nargs, argvec + 1));
9017 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
9018 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
9019 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9020 {
9021 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
9022 if (type == NULL)
9023 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
9024 else
9025 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9026 }
9027 return
9028 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0], type,
9029 nargs, argvec + 1));
9030
9031 default:
9032 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
9033 "array or function"));
9034 }
9035
9036 case TERNOP_SLICE:
9037 {
9038 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9039 struct value *low_bound_val =
9040 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9041 struct value *high_bound_val =
9042 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9043 LONGEST low_bound;
9044 LONGEST high_bound;
9045 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
9046 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
9047 low_bound = pos_atr (low_bound_val);
9048 high_bound = pos_atr (high_bound_val);
9049
9050 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9051 goto nosideret;
9052
9053 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
9054 the aligners. */
9055 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9056 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
9057 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
9058 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
9059
9060 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
9061 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
9062
9063 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
9064 convert to a pointer. */
9065 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9066 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9067 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
9068 array = value_addr (array);
9069
9070 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
9071 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
9072 (value_type (array))))
9073 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound);
9074
9075 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
9076
9077 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
9078 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
9079 while (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9080 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)))
9081 == TYPE_CODE_PTR))
9082 array = value_ind (array);
9083
9084 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
9085 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
9086 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
9087 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
9088 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
9089 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
9090
9091 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9092 {
9093 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9094 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)),
9095 low_bound);
9096 else
9097 {
9098 struct type *arr_type0 =
9099 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)),
9100 NULL, 1);
9101 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0,
9102 longest_to_int (low_bound),
9103 longest_to_int (high_bound));
9104 }
9105 }
9106 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9107 return array;
9108 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
9109 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound);
9110 else
9111 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
9112 longest_to_int (high_bound));
9113 }
9114
9115 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
9116 (*pos) += 2;
9117 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9118 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
9119
9120 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9121 goto nosideret;
9122
9123 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
9124 {
9125 default:
9126 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
9127 "always returns true"));
9128 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9129 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1);
9130
9131 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
9132 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
9133 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
9134 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9135 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9136 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9137 return
9138 value_from_longest (type,
9139 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9140 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9141 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9142 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9143 }
9144
9145 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
9146 (*pos) += 2;
9147 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9148 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9149
9150 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9151 goto nosideret;
9152
9153 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9154 {
9155 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9156 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9157 }
9158
9159 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9160
9161 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg2), tem, "range");
9162 if (!type)
9163 type = value_type (arg1);
9164
9165 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1));
9166 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0));
9167
9168 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9169 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9170 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9171 return
9172 value_from_longest (type,
9173 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9174 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9175 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9176 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9177
9178 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
9179 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9180 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9181 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9182
9183 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9184 goto nosideret;
9185
9186 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9187 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9188 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9189 return
9190 value_from_longest (type,
9191 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9192 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9193 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9194 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9195
9196 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9197 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9198 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9199 {
9200 struct type *type_arg;
9201 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
9202 {
9203 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9204 arg1 = NULL;
9205 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
9206 }
9207 else
9208 {
9209 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9210 type_arg = NULL;
9211 }
9212
9213 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
9214 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
9215 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
9216 *pos += 4;
9217
9218 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9219 goto nosideret;
9220
9221 if (type_arg == NULL)
9222 {
9223 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
9224
9225 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
9226 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9227
9228 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem,
9229 ada_attribute_name (op));
9230 if (type == NULL)
9231 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9232
9233 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9234 return allocate_value (type);
9235
9236 switch (op)
9237 {
9238 default: /* Should never happen. */
9239 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9240 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9241 return value_from_longest
9242 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0));
9243 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9244 return value_from_longest
9245 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1));
9246 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9247 return value_from_longest
9248 (type, ada_array_length (arg1, tem));
9249 }
9250 }
9251 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
9252 {
9253 struct type *range_type;
9254 char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
9255 range_type = NULL;
9256 if (name != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type_arg) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
9257 range_type = to_fixed_range_type (name, NULL, type_arg);
9258 if (range_type == NULL)
9259 range_type = type_arg;
9260 switch (op)
9261 {
9262 default:
9263 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9264 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9265 return value_from_longest
9266 (range_type, discrete_type_low_bound (range_type));
9267 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9268 return value_from_longest
9269 (range_type, discrete_type_high_bound (range_type));
9270 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9271 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
9272 }
9273 }
9274 else if (TYPE_CODE (type_arg) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
9275 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
9276 else
9277 {
9278 LONGEST low, high;
9279
9280 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
9281 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
9282
9283 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem, ada_attribute_name (op));
9284 if (type == NULL)
9285 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9286
9287 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9288 return allocate_value (type);
9289
9290 switch (op)
9291 {
9292 default:
9293 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9294 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9295 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
9296 return value_from_longest (type, low);
9297 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9298 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
9299 return value_from_longest (type, high);
9300 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9301 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
9302 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
9303 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
9304 }
9305 }
9306 }
9307
9308 case OP_ATR_TAG:
9309 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9310 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9311 goto nosideret;
9312
9313 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9314 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
9315
9316 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
9317
9318 case OP_ATR_MIN:
9319 case OP_ATR_MAX:
9320 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9321 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9322 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9323 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9324 goto nosideret;
9325 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9326 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9327 else
9328 {
9329 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9330 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
9331 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
9332 }
9333
9334 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
9335 {
9336 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
9337 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9338
9339 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9340 goto nosideret;
9341
9342 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
9343 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
9344
9345 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
9346 ada_modulus (type_arg));
9347 }
9348
9349
9350 case OP_ATR_POS:
9351 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9352 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9353 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9354 goto nosideret;
9355 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9356 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9357 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9358 else
9359 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1);
9360
9361 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
9362 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9363 type = value_type (arg1);
9364
9365 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since
9366 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object,
9367 not the size of the pointer. */
9368 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
9369 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9370
9371 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9372 goto nosideret;
9373 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9374 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, not_lval);
9375 else
9376 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
9377 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type));
9378
9379 case OP_ATR_VAL:
9380 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9381 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9382 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
9383 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9384 goto nosideret;
9385 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9386 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9387 else
9388 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
9389
9390 case BINOP_EXP:
9391 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9392 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9393 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9394 goto nosideret;
9395 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9396 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9397 else
9398 {
9399 /* For integer exponentiation operations,
9400 only promote the first argument. */
9401 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2)))
9402 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
9403 else
9404 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9405
9406 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9407 }
9408
9409 case UNOP_PLUS:
9410 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9411 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9412 goto nosideret;
9413 else
9414 return arg1;
9415
9416 case UNOP_ABS:
9417 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9418 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9419 goto nosideret;
9420 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
9421 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
9422 return value_neg (arg1);
9423 else
9424 return arg1;
9425
9426 case UNOP_IND:
9427 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9428 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9429 goto nosideret;
9430 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9431 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9432 {
9433 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9434 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
9435 {
9436 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
9437 if (arrType == NULL)
9438 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
9439 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
9440 }
9441 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9442 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9443 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
9444 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9445 {
9446 type = to_static_fixed_type
9447 (ada_aligned_type
9448 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
9449 check_size (type);
9450 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
9451 }
9452 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
9453 {
9454 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
9455 if (expect_type == NULL)
9456 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
9457 lval_memory);
9458 else
9459 {
9460 expect_type =
9461 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type));
9462 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory);
9463 }
9464 }
9465 else
9466 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
9467 }
9468 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
9469 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9470
9471 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
9472 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given
9473 the expect_type, then use that as the target type.
9474 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */
9475 {
9476 if (expect_type != NULL)
9477 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type),
9478 arg1));
9479 else
9480 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
9481 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1));
9482 }
9483
9484 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9485 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
9486 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9487 else
9488 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
9489
9490 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
9491 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9492 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
9493 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9494 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9495 goto nosideret;
9496 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9497 {
9498 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
9499 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
9500 {
9501 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
9502 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
9503 1, 1, NULL);
9504 if (type == NULL)
9505 /* In this case, we assume that the field COULD exist
9506 in some extension of the type. Return an object of
9507 "type" void, which will match any formal
9508 (see ada_type_match). */
9509 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_void,
9510 lval_memory);
9511 }
9512 else
9513 type =
9514 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
9515 0, NULL);
9516
9517 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9518 }
9519 else
9520 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0);
9521 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
9522 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
9523
9524 case OP_TYPE:
9525 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
9526 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
9527 (*pos) += 2;
9528 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9529 goto nosideret;
9530 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9531 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
9532 else
9533 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
9534
9535 case OP_AGGREGATE:
9536 case OP_CHOICES:
9537 case OP_OTHERS:
9538 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
9539 case OP_POSITIONAL:
9540 case OP_NAME:
9541 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
9542 switch (op)
9543 {
9544 case OP_NAME:
9545 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
9546 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
9547 case OP_AGGREGATE:
9548 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
9549 default:
9550 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
9551 }
9552
9553 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
9554 *pos += oplen - 1;
9555 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
9556 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
9557 goto nosideret;
9558 }
9559
9560 nosideret:
9561 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 1);
9562 }
9563 \f
9564
9565 /* Fixed point */
9566
9567 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
9568 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
9569 Otherwise, return NULL. */
9570
9571 static const char *
9572 fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
9573 {
9574 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
9575 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : TYPE_CODE (type);
9576
9577 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
9578 {
9579 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
9580 if (tail == NULL)
9581 return NULL;
9582 else
9583 return tail + 5;
9584 }
9585 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
9586 return fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
9587 else
9588 return NULL;
9589 }
9590
9591 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
9592
9593 int
9594 ada_is_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
9595 {
9596 return fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
9597 }
9598
9599 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
9600
9601 int
9602 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
9603 {
9604 return (TYPE_NAME (type)
9605 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (type), "system__address") == 0);
9606 }
9607
9608 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
9609 type, return its delta, or -1 if the type is malformed and the
9610 delta cannot be determined. */
9611
9612 DOUBLEST
9613 ada_delta (struct type *type)
9614 {
9615 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
9616 DOUBLEST num, den;
9617
9618 /* Strictly speaking, num and den are encoded as integer. However,
9619 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
9620 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
9621 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
9622 &num, &den) < 2)
9623 return -1.0;
9624 else
9625 return num / den;
9626 }
9627
9628 /* Assuming that ada_is_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return the scaling
9629 factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
9630
9631 static DOUBLEST
9632 scaling_factor (struct type *type)
9633 {
9634 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
9635 DOUBLEST num0, den0, num1, den1;
9636 int n;
9637
9638 /* Strictly speaking, num's and den's are encoded as integer. However,
9639 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
9640 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
9641 n = sscanf (encoding,
9642 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT
9643 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
9644 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
9645
9646 if (n < 2)
9647 return 1.0;
9648 else if (n == 4)
9649 return num1 / den1;
9650 else
9651 return num0 / den0;
9652 }
9653
9654
9655 /* Assuming that X is the representation of a value of fixed-point
9656 type TYPE, return its floating-point equivalent. */
9657
9658 DOUBLEST
9659 ada_fixed_to_float (struct type *type, LONGEST x)
9660 {
9661 return (DOUBLEST) x *scaling_factor (type);
9662 }
9663
9664 /* The representation of a fixed-point value of type TYPE
9665 corresponding to the value X. */
9666
9667 LONGEST
9668 ada_float_to_fixed (struct type *type, DOUBLEST x)
9669 {
9670 return (LONGEST) (x / scaling_factor (type) + 0.5);
9671 }
9672
9673
9674 /* VAX floating formats */
9675
9676 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents one of the special VAX floating-point
9677 types. */
9678
9679 int
9680 ada_is_vax_floating_type (struct type *type)
9681 {
9682 int name_len =
9683 (ada_type_name (type) == NULL) ? 0 : strlen (ada_type_name (type));
9684 return
9685 name_len > 6
9686 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
9687 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9688 && strncmp (ada_type_name (type) + name_len - 6, "___XF", 5) == 0;
9689 }
9690
9691 /* The type of special VAX floating-point type this is, assuming
9692 ada_is_vax_floating_point. */
9693
9694 int
9695 ada_vax_float_type_suffix (struct type *type)
9696 {
9697 return ada_type_name (type)[strlen (ada_type_name (type)) - 1];
9698 }
9699
9700 /* A value representing the special debugging function that outputs
9701 VAX floating-point values of the type represented by TYPE. Assumes
9702 ada_is_vax_floating_type (TYPE). */
9703
9704 struct value *
9705 ada_vax_float_print_function (struct type *type)
9706 {
9707 switch (ada_vax_float_type_suffix (type))
9708 {
9709 case 'F':
9710 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_F", 0);
9711 case 'D':
9712 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_D", 0);
9713 case 'G':
9714 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_G", 0);
9715 default:
9716 error (_("invalid VAX floating-point type"));
9717 }
9718 }
9719 \f
9720
9721 /* Range types */
9722
9723 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
9724 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
9725 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
9726 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
9727 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
9728
9729 static int
9730 scan_discrim_bound (char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
9731 int *pnew_k)
9732 {
9733 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
9734 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
9735 char *bound;
9736 char *pend;
9737 struct value *bound_val;
9738
9739 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
9740 return 0;
9741
9742 pend = strstr (str + k, "__");
9743 if (pend == NULL)
9744 {
9745 bound = str + k;
9746 k += strlen (bound);
9747 }
9748 else
9749 {
9750 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, pend - (str + k) + 1);
9751 bound = bound_buffer;
9752 strncpy (bound_buffer, str + k, pend - (str + k));
9753 bound[pend - (str + k)] = '\0';
9754 k = pend - str;
9755 }
9756
9757 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
9758 if (bound_val == NULL)
9759 return 0;
9760
9761 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
9762 if (pnew_k != NULL)
9763 *pnew_k = k;
9764 return 1;
9765 }
9766
9767 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
9768 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
9769 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
9770
9771 static struct value *
9772 get_var_value (char *name, char *err_msg)
9773 {
9774 struct ada_symbol_info *syms;
9775 int nsyms;
9776
9777 nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN,
9778 &syms);
9779
9780 if (nsyms != 1)
9781 {
9782 if (err_msg == NULL)
9783 return 0;
9784 else
9785 error (("%s"), err_msg);
9786 }
9787
9788 return value_of_variable (syms[0].sym, syms[0].block);
9789 }
9790
9791 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment. If
9792 no such variable found, returns 0, and sets *FLAG to 0. If
9793 successful, sets *FLAG to 1. */
9794
9795 LONGEST
9796 get_int_var_value (char *name, int *flag)
9797 {
9798 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
9799
9800 if (var_val == 0)
9801 {
9802 if (flag != NULL)
9803 *flag = 0;
9804 return 0;
9805 }
9806 else
9807 {
9808 if (flag != NULL)
9809 *flag = 1;
9810 return value_as_long (var_val);
9811 }
9812 }
9813
9814
9815 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
9816 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
9817 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
9818 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. ORIG_TYPE is the
9819 corresponding range type from debug information; fall back to using it
9820 if symbol lookup fails. If a new type must be created, allocate it
9821 like ORIG_TYPE was. The bounds information, in general, is encoded
9822 in NAME, the base type given in the named range type. */
9823
9824 static struct type *
9825 to_fixed_range_type (char *name, struct value *dval, struct type *orig_type)
9826 {
9827 struct type *raw_type = ada_find_any_type (name);
9828 struct type *base_type;
9829 char *subtype_info;
9830
9831 /* Fall back to the original type if symbol lookup failed. */
9832 if (raw_type == NULL)
9833 raw_type = orig_type;
9834
9835 if (TYPE_CODE (raw_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9836 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
9837 else
9838 base_type = raw_type;
9839
9840 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
9841 if (subtype_info == NULL)
9842 {
9843 LONGEST L = discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type);
9844 LONGEST U = discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type);
9845 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX)
9846 return raw_type;
9847 else
9848 return create_range_type (alloc_type_copy (orig_type), raw_type,
9849 discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type),
9850 discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type));
9851 }
9852 else
9853 {
9854 static char *name_buf = NULL;
9855 static size_t name_len = 0;
9856 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
9857 LONGEST L, U;
9858 struct type *type;
9859 char *bounds_str;
9860 int n;
9861
9862 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
9863 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
9864 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
9865
9866 subtype_info += 5;
9867 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
9868 n = 1;
9869
9870 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
9871 {
9872 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
9873 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
9874 return raw_type;
9875 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
9876 n += 2;
9877 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
9878 n += 1;
9879 subtype_info += 1;
9880 }
9881 else
9882 {
9883 int ok;
9884 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
9885 L = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
9886 if (!ok)
9887 {
9888 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
9889 L = 1;
9890 }
9891 }
9892
9893 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
9894 {
9895 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
9896 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
9897 return raw_type;
9898 }
9899 else
9900 {
9901 int ok;
9902 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
9903 U = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
9904 if (!ok)
9905 {
9906 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
9907 U = L;
9908 }
9909 }
9910
9911 type = create_range_type (alloc_type_copy (orig_type), base_type, L, U);
9912 TYPE_NAME (type) = name;
9913 return type;
9914 }
9915 }
9916
9917 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
9918
9919 int
9920 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
9921 {
9922 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
9923 }
9924 \f
9925
9926 /* Modular types */
9927
9928 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
9929
9930 int
9931 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
9932 {
9933 struct type *subranged_type = base_type (type);
9934
9935 return (subranged_type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
9936 && TYPE_CODE (subranged_type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
9937 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
9938 }
9939
9940 /* Try to determine the lower and upper bounds of the given modular type
9941 using the type name only. Return non-zero and set L and U as the lower
9942 and upper bounds (respectively) if successful. */
9943
9944 int
9945 ada_modulus_from_name (struct type *type, ULONGEST *modulus)
9946 {
9947 char *name = ada_type_name (type);
9948 char *suffix;
9949 int k;
9950 LONGEST U;
9951
9952 if (name == NULL)
9953 return 0;
9954
9955 /* Discrete type bounds are encoded using an __XD suffix. In our case,
9956 we are looking for static bounds, which means an __XDLU suffix.
9957 Moreover, we know that the lower bound of modular types is always
9958 zero, so the actual suffix should start with "__XDLU_0__", and
9959 then be followed by the upper bound value. */
9960 suffix = strstr (name, "__XDLU_0__");
9961 if (suffix == NULL)
9962 return 0;
9963 k = 10;
9964 if (!ada_scan_number (suffix, k, &U, NULL))
9965 return 0;
9966
9967 *modulus = (ULONGEST) U + 1;
9968 return 1;
9969 }
9970
9971 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
9972
9973 ULONGEST
9974 ada_modulus (struct type *type)
9975 {
9976 ULONGEST modulus;
9977
9978 /* Normally, the modulus of a modular type is equal to the value of
9979 its upper bound + 1. However, the upper bound is currently stored
9980 as an int, which is not always big enough to hold the actual bound
9981 value. To workaround this, try to take advantage of the encoding
9982 that GNAT uses with with discrete types. To avoid some unnecessary
9983 parsing, we do this only when the size of TYPE is greater than
9984 the size of the field holding the bound. */
9985 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > sizeof (TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type))
9986 && ada_modulus_from_name (type, &modulus))
9987 return modulus;
9988
9989 return (ULONGEST) (unsigned int) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
9990 }
9991 \f
9992
9993 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
9994 ---------------------------------
9995
9996 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
9997 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
9998 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
9999 . catchpoints on failed assertions
10000
10001 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
10002 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
10003 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
10004 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
10005 to zero-in on certain situations.
10006
10007 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
10008 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
10009 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
10010 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
10011 of breakpoint_ops.
10012
10013 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
10014 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
10015 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
10016 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
10017 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged.
10018
10019 At this time, we do not support the use of conditions on Ada exception
10020 catchpoints. The COND and COND_STRING fields are therefore set
10021 to NULL (most of the time, see below).
10022
10023 Conditions where EXP_STRING, COND, and COND_STRING are used:
10024
10025 When a user specifies the name of a specific exception in the case
10026 of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, we store the name of that exception
10027 in the EXP_STRING. We then translate this request into an actual
10028 condition stored in COND_STRING, and then parse it into an expression
10029 stored in COND. */
10030
10031 /* The different types of catchpoints that we introduced for catching
10032 Ada exceptions. */
10033
10034 enum exception_catchpoint_kind
10035 {
10036 ex_catch_exception,
10037 ex_catch_exception_unhandled,
10038 ex_catch_assert
10039 };
10040
10041 /* Ada's standard exceptions. */
10042
10043 static char *standard_exc[] = {
10044 "constraint_error",
10045 "program_error",
10046 "storage_error",
10047 "tasking_error"
10048 };
10049
10050 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
10051
10052 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
10053 for a given executable. */
10054
10055 struct exception_support_info
10056 {
10057 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10058 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
10059 const char *catch_exception_sym;
10060
10061 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10062 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
10063 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
10064
10065 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10066 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
10067 const char *catch_assert_sym;
10068
10069 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
10070 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
10071 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
10072 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
10073 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
10074 };
10075
10076 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
10077 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
10078
10079 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
10080 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
10081 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06). */
10082
10083 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
10084 {
10085 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
10086 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
10087 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
10088 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
10089 };
10090
10091 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
10092 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
10093 of the Ada runtime. */
10094
10095 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
10096 {
10097 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
10098 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
10099 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
10100 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
10101 };
10102
10103 /* For each executable, we sniff which exception info structure to use
10104 and cache it in the following global variable. */
10105
10106 static const struct exception_support_info *exception_info = NULL;
10107
10108 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
10109 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
10110
10111 This function will always set exception_info, or raise an error. */
10112
10113 static void
10114 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
10115 {
10116 struct symbol *sym;
10117
10118 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
10119 if (exception_info != NULL)
10120 return;
10121
10122 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
10123 sym = standard_lookup (default_exception_support_info.catch_exception_sym,
10124 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
10125 if (sym != NULL)
10126 {
10127 exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
10128 return;
10129 }
10130
10131 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
10132 sym = standard_lookup (exception_support_info_fallback.catch_exception_sym,
10133 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
10134 if (sym != NULL)
10135 {
10136 exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
10137 return;
10138 }
10139
10140 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
10141 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
10142 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
10143 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
10144 applicable. */
10145
10146 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown, NULL) != language_ada)
10147 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
10148
10149 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
10150 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
10151 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
10152 in a shared library. */
10153
10154 if (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid) == 0)
10155 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
10156
10157 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
10158 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
10159 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
10160 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
10161 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
10162 supporting this feature. */
10163
10164 error (_("Cannot insert catchpoints in this configuration."));
10165 }
10166
10167 /* An observer of "executable_changed" events.
10168 Its role is to clear certain cached values that need to be recomputed
10169 each time a new executable is loaded by GDB. */
10170
10171 static void
10172 ada_executable_changed_observer (void)
10173 {
10174 /* If the executable changed, then it is possible that the Ada runtime
10175 is different. So we need to invalidate the exception support info
10176 cache. */
10177 exception_info = NULL;
10178 }
10179
10180 /* Return the name of the function at PC, NULL if could not find it.
10181 This function only checks the debugging information, not the symbol
10182 table. */
10183
10184 static char *
10185 function_name_from_pc (CORE_ADDR pc)
10186 {
10187 char *func_name;
10188
10189 if (!find_pc_partial_function (pc, &func_name, NULL, NULL))
10190 return NULL;
10191
10192 return func_name;
10193 }
10194
10195 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
10196 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
10197 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
10198 to most users. */
10199
10200 static int
10201 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
10202 {
10203 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10204 char *func_name;
10205 int i;
10206
10207 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
10208 This cannot be any user code. */
10209
10210 find_frame_sal (frame, &sal);
10211 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
10212 return 1;
10213
10214 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
10215 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
10216 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
10217 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
10218 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
10219
10220 if (symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab) == NULL)
10221 return 1;
10222
10223 /* Check the unit filename againt the Ada runtime file naming.
10224 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
10225 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
10226 too. */
10227
10228 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
10229 {
10230 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
10231 if (re_exec (sal.symtab->filename))
10232 return 1;
10233 if (sal.symtab->objfile != NULL
10234 && re_exec (sal.symtab->objfile->name))
10235 return 1;
10236 }
10237
10238 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
10239
10240 func_name = function_name_from_pc (get_frame_address_in_block (frame));
10241 if (func_name == NULL)
10242 return 1;
10243
10244 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
10245 {
10246 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
10247 if (re_exec (func_name))
10248 return 1;
10249 }
10250
10251 return 0;
10252 }
10253
10254 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
10255 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
10256
10257 void
10258 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
10259 {
10260 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
10261 {
10262 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
10263 {
10264 select_frame (fi);
10265 break;
10266 }
10267 }
10268
10269 }
10270
10271 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
10272 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
10273 of the exception is stored.
10274
10275 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
10276
10277 static CORE_ADDR
10278 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
10279 {
10280 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
10281 }
10282
10283 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
10284 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
10285 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
10286 several frames up in the callstack. */
10287
10288 static CORE_ADDR
10289 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
10290 {
10291 int frame_level;
10292 struct frame_info *fi;
10293
10294 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
10295 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
10296 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
10297 without checking the name of their associated function. */
10298 fi = get_current_frame ();
10299 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
10300 if (fi != NULL)
10301 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
10302
10303 while (fi != NULL)
10304 {
10305 const char *func_name =
10306 function_name_from_pc (get_frame_address_in_block (fi));
10307 if (func_name != NULL
10308 && strcmp (func_name, exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
10309 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
10310 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
10311 }
10312
10313 if (fi == NULL)
10314 return 0;
10315
10316 select_frame (fi);
10317 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
10318 }
10319
10320 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
10321 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
10322 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
10323
10324 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
10325
10326 static CORE_ADDR
10327 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10328 struct breakpoint *b)
10329 {
10330 switch (ex)
10331 {
10332 case ex_catch_exception:
10333 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
10334 break;
10335
10336 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10337 return exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
10338 break;
10339
10340 case ex_catch_assert:
10341 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
10342 break;
10343
10344 default:
10345 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10346 break;
10347 }
10348
10349 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
10350 }
10351
10352 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
10353 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
10354 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
10355 and zero is returned. */
10356
10357 static CORE_ADDR
10358 ada_exception_name_addr (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10359 struct breakpoint *b)
10360 {
10361 struct gdb_exception e;
10362 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
10363
10364 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
10365 {
10366 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
10367 }
10368
10369 if (e.reason < 0)
10370 {
10371 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.message);
10372 return 0;
10373 }
10374
10375 return result;
10376 }
10377
10378 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10379 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10380
10381 static enum print_stop_action
10382 print_it_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
10383 {
10384 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (ex, b);
10385 char exception_name[256];
10386
10387 if (addr != 0)
10388 {
10389 read_memory (addr, exception_name, sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
10390 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
10391 }
10392
10393 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
10394
10395 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
10396 switch (ex)
10397 {
10398 case ex_catch_exception:
10399 if (addr != 0)
10400 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, %s at "),
10401 b->number, exception_name);
10402 else
10403 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, exception at "), b->number);
10404 break;
10405 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10406 if (addr != 0)
10407 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, unhandled %s at "),
10408 b->number, exception_name);
10409 else
10410 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, unhandled exception at "),
10411 b->number);
10412 break;
10413 case ex_catch_assert:
10414 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, failed assertion at "),
10415 b->number);
10416 break;
10417 }
10418
10419 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
10420 }
10421
10422 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10423 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10424
10425 static void
10426 print_one_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10427 struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
10428 {
10429 struct value_print_options opts;
10430
10431 get_user_print_options (&opts);
10432 if (opts.addressprint)
10433 {
10434 annotate_field (4);
10435 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr", b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
10436 }
10437
10438 annotate_field (5);
10439 *last_loc = b->loc;
10440 switch (ex)
10441 {
10442 case ex_catch_exception:
10443 if (b->exp_string != NULL)
10444 {
10445 char *msg = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), b->exp_string);
10446
10447 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
10448 xfree (msg);
10449 }
10450 else
10451 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "all Ada exceptions");
10452
10453 break;
10454
10455 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10456 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
10457 break;
10458
10459 case ex_catch_assert:
10460 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "failed Ada assertions");
10461 break;
10462
10463 default:
10464 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10465 break;
10466 }
10467 }
10468
10469 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10470 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10471
10472 static void
10473 print_mention_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10474 struct breakpoint *b)
10475 {
10476 switch (ex)
10477 {
10478 case ex_catch_exception:
10479 if (b->exp_string != NULL)
10480 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: `%s' Ada exception"),
10481 b->number, b->exp_string);
10482 else
10483 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: all Ada exceptions"), b->number);
10484
10485 break;
10486
10487 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10488 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: unhandled Ada exceptions"),
10489 b->number);
10490 break;
10491
10492 case ex_catch_assert:
10493 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: failed Ada assertions"), b->number);
10494 break;
10495
10496 default:
10497 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10498 break;
10499 }
10500 }
10501
10502 /* Virtual table for "catch exception" breakpoints. */
10503
10504 static enum print_stop_action
10505 print_it_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
10506 {
10507 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
10508 }
10509
10510 static void
10511 print_one_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
10512 {
10513 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception, b, last_loc);
10514 }
10515
10516 static void
10517 print_mention_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
10518 {
10519 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
10520 }
10521
10522 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops =
10523 {
10524 NULL, /* insert */
10525 NULL, /* remove */
10526 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
10527 print_it_catch_exception,
10528 print_one_catch_exception,
10529 print_mention_catch_exception
10530 };
10531
10532 /* Virtual table for "catch exception unhandled" breakpoints. */
10533
10534 static enum print_stop_action
10535 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
10536 {
10537 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
10538 }
10539
10540 static void
10541 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b,
10542 struct bp_location **last_loc)
10543 {
10544 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b, last_loc);
10545 }
10546
10547 static void
10548 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
10549 {
10550 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
10551 }
10552
10553 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops = {
10554 NULL, /* insert */
10555 NULL, /* remove */
10556 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
10557 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled,
10558 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled,
10559 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled
10560 };
10561
10562 /* Virtual table for "catch assert" breakpoints. */
10563
10564 static enum print_stop_action
10565 print_it_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
10566 {
10567 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
10568 }
10569
10570 static void
10571 print_one_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
10572 {
10573 print_one_exception (ex_catch_assert, b, last_loc);
10574 }
10575
10576 static void
10577 print_mention_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
10578 {
10579 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
10580 }
10581
10582 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops = {
10583 NULL, /* insert */
10584 NULL, /* remove */
10585 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
10586 print_it_catch_assert,
10587 print_one_catch_assert,
10588 print_mention_catch_assert
10589 };
10590
10591 /* Return non-zero if B is an Ada exception catchpoint. */
10592
10593 int
10594 ada_exception_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
10595 {
10596 return (b->ops == &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops
10597 || b->ops == &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops
10598 || b->ops == &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
10599 }
10600
10601 /* Return a newly allocated copy of the first space-separated token
10602 in ARGSP, and then adjust ARGSP to point immediately after that
10603 token.
10604
10605 Return NULL if ARGPS does not contain any more tokens. */
10606
10607 static char *
10608 ada_get_next_arg (char **argsp)
10609 {
10610 char *args = *argsp;
10611 char *end;
10612 char *result;
10613
10614 /* Skip any leading white space. */
10615
10616 while (isspace (*args))
10617 args++;
10618
10619 if (args[0] == '\0')
10620 return NULL; /* No more arguments. */
10621
10622 /* Find the end of the current argument. */
10623
10624 end = args;
10625 while (*end != '\0' && !isspace (*end))
10626 end++;
10627
10628 /* Adjust ARGSP to point to the start of the next argument. */
10629
10630 *argsp = end;
10631
10632 /* Make a copy of the current argument and return it. */
10633
10634 result = xmalloc (end - args + 1);
10635 strncpy (result, args, end - args);
10636 result[end - args] = '\0';
10637
10638 return result;
10639 }
10640
10641 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
10642 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
10643 Set EXP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
10644 specified by the user. */
10645
10646 static void
10647 catch_ada_exception_command_split (char *args,
10648 enum exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
10649 char **exp_string)
10650 {
10651 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
10652 char *exception_name;
10653
10654 exception_name = ada_get_next_arg (&args);
10655 make_cleanup (xfree, exception_name);
10656
10657 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
10658 is unexpected. */
10659
10660 while (isspace (*args))
10661 args++;
10662
10663 if (args[0] != '\0')
10664 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
10665
10666 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
10667
10668 if (exception_name == NULL)
10669 {
10670 /* Catch all exceptions. */
10671 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
10672 *exp_string = NULL;
10673 }
10674 else if (strcmp (exception_name, "unhandled") == 0)
10675 {
10676 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
10677 *ex = ex_catch_exception_unhandled;
10678 *exp_string = NULL;
10679 }
10680 else
10681 {
10682 /* Catch a specific exception. */
10683 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
10684 *exp_string = exception_name;
10685 }
10686 }
10687
10688 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
10689 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
10690
10691 static const char *
10692 ada_exception_sym_name (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
10693 {
10694 gdb_assert (exception_info != NULL);
10695
10696 switch (ex)
10697 {
10698 case ex_catch_exception:
10699 return (exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
10700 break;
10701 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10702 return (exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
10703 break;
10704 case ex_catch_assert:
10705 return (exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
10706 break;
10707 default:
10708 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10709 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
10710 }
10711 }
10712
10713 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
10714 of the EX kind. */
10715
10716 static struct breakpoint_ops *
10717 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
10718 {
10719 switch (ex)
10720 {
10721 case ex_catch_exception:
10722 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
10723 break;
10724 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10725 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
10726 break;
10727 case ex_catch_assert:
10728 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
10729 break;
10730 default:
10731 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10732 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
10733 }
10734 }
10735
10736 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
10737 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
10738 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
10739 an exception catchpoint.
10740
10741 The string returned is a newly allocated string that needs to be
10742 deallocated later. */
10743
10744 static char *
10745 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *exp_string)
10746 {
10747 int i;
10748
10749 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in
10750 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if
10751 EXP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard
10752 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation
10753 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would
10754 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition
10755 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the
10756 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error).
10757
10758 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are
10759 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch
10760 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception
10761 standard.constraint_error".
10762
10763 If an exception named contraint_error is defined in another package of
10764 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a
10765 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named:
10766 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */
10767
10768 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++)
10769 {
10770 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], exp_string) == 0)
10771 {
10772 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&standard.%s)",
10773 exp_string);
10774 }
10775 }
10776 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&%s)", exp_string);
10777 }
10778
10779 /* Return the expression corresponding to COND_STRING evaluated at SAL. */
10780
10781 static struct expression *
10782 ada_parse_catchpoint_condition (char *cond_string,
10783 struct symtab_and_line sal)
10784 {
10785 return (parse_exp_1 (&cond_string, block_for_pc (sal.pc), 0));
10786 }
10787
10788 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
10789 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
10790
10791 EX_STRING should contain the name of a specific exception
10792 that the catchpoint should catch, or NULL otherwise.
10793
10794 The idea behind all the remaining parameters is that their names match
10795 the name of certain fields in the breakpoint structure that are used to
10796 handle exception catchpoints. This function returns the value to which
10797 these fields should be set, depending on the type of catchpoint we need
10798 to create.
10799
10800 If COND and COND_STRING are both non-NULL, any value they might
10801 hold will be free'ed, and then replaced by newly allocated ones.
10802 These parameters are left untouched otherwise. */
10803
10804 static struct symtab_and_line
10805 ada_exception_sal (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, char *exp_string,
10806 char **addr_string, char **cond_string,
10807 struct expression **cond, struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10808 {
10809 const char *sym_name;
10810 struct symbol *sym;
10811 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10812
10813 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
10814 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
10815
10816 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
10817 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
10818
10819 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
10820 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
10821
10822 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
10823 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
10824 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. If we don't find it, then
10825 the target most likely does not support Ada exceptions, or we cannot
10826 insert exception breakpoints yet, because the GNAT runtime hasn't been
10827 loaded yet. */
10828
10829 /* brobecker/2006-12-26: It is conceivable that the runtime was compiled
10830 in such a way that no debugging information is produced for the symbol
10831 we are looking for. In this case, we could search the minimal symbols
10832 as a fall-back mechanism. This would still be operating in degraded
10833 mode, however, as we would still be missing the debugging information
10834 that is needed in order to extract the name of the exception being
10835 raised (this name is printed in the catchpoint message, and is also
10836 used when trying to catch a specific exception). We do not handle
10837 this case for now. */
10838
10839 if (sym == NULL)
10840 error (_("Unable to break on '%s' in this configuration."), sym_name);
10841
10842 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
10843 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
10844 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
10845 sym_name, SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
10846
10847 sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
10848
10849 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
10850
10851 *addr_string = xstrdup (sym_name);
10852
10853 /* Set the COND and COND_STRING (if not NULL). */
10854
10855 if (cond_string != NULL && cond != NULL)
10856 {
10857 if (*cond_string != NULL)
10858 {
10859 xfree (*cond_string);
10860 *cond_string = NULL;
10861 }
10862 if (*cond != NULL)
10863 {
10864 xfree (*cond);
10865 *cond = NULL;
10866 }
10867 if (exp_string != NULL)
10868 {
10869 *cond_string = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (exp_string);
10870 *cond = ada_parse_catchpoint_condition (*cond_string, sal);
10871 }
10872 }
10873
10874 /* Set OPS. */
10875 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
10876
10877 return sal;
10878 }
10879
10880 /* Parse the arguments (ARGS) of the "catch exception" command.
10881
10882 Set TYPE to the appropriate exception catchpoint type.
10883 If the user asked the catchpoint to catch only a specific
10884 exception, then save the exception name in ADDR_STRING.
10885
10886 See ada_exception_sal for a description of all the remaining
10887 function arguments of this function. */
10888
10889 struct symtab_and_line
10890 ada_decode_exception_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
10891 char **exp_string, char **cond_string,
10892 struct expression **cond,
10893 struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10894 {
10895 enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex;
10896
10897 catch_ada_exception_command_split (args, &ex, exp_string);
10898 return ada_exception_sal (ex, *exp_string, addr_string, cond_string,
10899 cond, ops);
10900 }
10901
10902 struct symtab_and_line
10903 ada_decode_assert_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
10904 struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10905 {
10906 /* Check that no argument where provided at the end of the command. */
10907
10908 if (args != NULL)
10909 {
10910 while (isspace (*args))
10911 args++;
10912 if (*args != '\0')
10913 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10914 }
10915
10916 return ada_exception_sal (ex_catch_assert, NULL, addr_string, NULL, NULL,
10917 ops);
10918 }
10919
10920 /* Operators */
10921 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
10922 below. */
10923 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
10924
10925 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
10926 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
10927 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
10928 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
10929 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
10930 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
10931 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
10932 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
10933 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
10934 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
10935 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
10936 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
10937 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
10938 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
10939 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
10940 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
10941 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
10942 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
10943 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
10944 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
10945
10946 static void
10947 ada_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp, int *argsp)
10948 {
10949 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
10950 {
10951 default:
10952 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
10953 break;
10954
10955 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
10956 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
10957 ADA_OPERATORS;
10958 #undef OP_DEFN
10959
10960 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10961 *oplenp = 3;
10962 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
10963 break;
10964
10965 case OP_CHOICES:
10966 *oplenp = 3;
10967 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
10968 break;
10969 }
10970 }
10971
10972 static char *
10973 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
10974 {
10975 switch (opcode)
10976 {
10977 default:
10978 return op_name_standard (opcode);
10979
10980 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
10981 ADA_OPERATORS;
10982 #undef OP_DEFN
10983
10984 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10985 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
10986 case OP_CHOICES:
10987 return "OP_CHOICES";
10988 case OP_NAME:
10989 return "OP_NAME";
10990 }
10991 }
10992
10993 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
10994 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
10995 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
10996
10997 static void
10998 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
10999 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
11000 {
11001 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
11002 {
11003 default:
11004 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
11005 break;
11006
11007 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
11008 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
11009 ADA_OPERATORS;
11010 #undef OP_DEFN
11011
11012 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11013 *oplenp = 3;
11014 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
11015 break;
11016
11017 case OP_CHOICES:
11018 *oplenp = 3;
11019 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
11020 break;
11021
11022 case OP_STRING:
11023 case OP_NAME:
11024 {
11025 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
11026 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
11027 *argsp = 0;
11028 break;
11029 }
11030 }
11031 }
11032
11033 static int
11034 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
11035 {
11036 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
11037 int oplen, nargs;
11038 int pc = elt;
11039 int i;
11040
11041 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
11042
11043 switch (op)
11044 {
11045 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
11046 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11047 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11048 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11049 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
11050 case OP_ATR_MAX:
11051 case OP_ATR_MIN:
11052 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
11053 case OP_ATR_POS:
11054 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
11055 case OP_ATR_TAG:
11056 case OP_ATR_VAL:
11057 break;
11058
11059 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
11060 case UNOP_QUAL:
11061 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
11062 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
11063 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
11064 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
11065 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
11066 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
11067 break;
11068 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
11069 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
11070 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
11071 break;
11072 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
11073 break;
11074
11075 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11076 case OP_OTHERS:
11077 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
11078 case OP_POSITIONAL:
11079 case OP_CHOICES:
11080 break;
11081
11082 case OP_NAME:
11083 case OP_STRING:
11084 {
11085 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
11086 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
11087 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
11088 break;
11089 }
11090
11091 default:
11092 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
11093 }
11094
11095 elt += oplen;
11096 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
11097 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
11098
11099 return elt;
11100 }
11101
11102 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
11103
11104 static void
11105 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
11106 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
11107 {
11108 int oplen, nargs, i;
11109 int pc = *pos;
11110 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
11111
11112 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
11113
11114 *pos += oplen;
11115 switch (op)
11116 {
11117 default:
11118 *pos -= oplen;
11119 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
11120 return;
11121
11122 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
11123 fputs_filtered (SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), stream);
11124 return;
11125
11126 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
11127 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
11128 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11129 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
11130 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11131 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
11132 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
11133 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
11134 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
11135 return;
11136
11137 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
11138 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
11139 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
11140 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
11141 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11142 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
11143 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
11144 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
11145 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
11146 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
11147 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
11148 return;
11149
11150 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11151 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11152 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11153 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
11154 case OP_ATR_MAX:
11155 case OP_ATR_MIN:
11156 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
11157 case OP_ATR_POS:
11158 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
11159 case OP_ATR_TAG:
11160 case OP_ATR_VAL:
11161 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
11162 {
11163 if (TYPE_CODE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
11164 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0);
11165 *pos += 3;
11166 }
11167 else
11168 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11169 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
11170 if (nargs > 1)
11171 {
11172 int tem;
11173 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
11174 {
11175 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
11176 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
11177 }
11178 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
11179 }
11180 return;
11181
11182 case UNOP_QUAL:
11183 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
11184 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
11185 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
11186 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
11187 return;
11188
11189 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
11190 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
11191 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11192 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
11193 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0);
11194 return;
11195
11196 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
11197 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11198 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
11199 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11200 return;
11201
11202 case OP_OTHERS:
11203 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
11204 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11205 return;
11206
11207 case OP_CHOICES:
11208 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
11209 {
11210 if (i > 0)
11211 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
11212 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11213 }
11214 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
11215 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11216 return;
11217
11218 case OP_POSITIONAL:
11219 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11220 return;
11221
11222 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11223 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
11224 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
11225 {
11226 if (i > 0)
11227 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
11228 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
11229 }
11230 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
11231 return;
11232 }
11233 }
11234
11235 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
11236 and precedences of the operators. */
11237
11238 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
11239 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
11240 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
11241 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
11242 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
11243 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
11244 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
11245 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
11246 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
11247 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
11248 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
11249 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
11250 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
11251 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
11252 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
11253 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
11254 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
11255 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
11256 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
11257 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
11258 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
11259 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
11260 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
11261 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
11262 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
11263 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
11264 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
11265 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
11266 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
11267 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
11268 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
11269 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
11270 {NULL, 0, 0, 0}
11271 };
11272 \f
11273 enum ada_primitive_types {
11274 ada_primitive_type_int,
11275 ada_primitive_type_long,
11276 ada_primitive_type_short,
11277 ada_primitive_type_char,
11278 ada_primitive_type_float,
11279 ada_primitive_type_double,
11280 ada_primitive_type_void,
11281 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
11282 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
11283 ada_primitive_type_natural,
11284 ada_primitive_type_positive,
11285 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
11286 nr_ada_primitive_types
11287 };
11288
11289 static void
11290 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11291 struct language_arch_info *lai)
11292 {
11293 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
11294 lai->primitive_type_vector
11295 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
11296 struct type *);
11297
11298 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int]
11299 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
11300 0, "integer");
11301 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long]
11302 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch),
11303 0, "long_integer");
11304 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short]
11305 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch),
11306 0, "short_integer");
11307 lai->string_char_type
11308 = lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char]
11309 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, TARGET_CHAR_BIT, 0, "character");
11310 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float]
11311 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch),
11312 "float", NULL);
11313 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double]
11314 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
11315 "long_float", NULL);
11316 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long]
11317 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch),
11318 0, "long_long_integer");
11319 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double]
11320 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
11321 "long_long_float", NULL);
11322 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural]
11323 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
11324 0, "natural");
11325 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive]
11326 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
11327 0, "positive");
11328 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void]
11329 = builtin->builtin_void;
11330
11331 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
11332 = lookup_pointer_type (arch_type (gdbarch, TYPE_CODE_VOID, 1, "void"));
11333 TYPE_NAME (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address])
11334 = "system__address";
11335
11336 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL;
11337 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool;
11338 }
11339 \f
11340 /* Language vector */
11341
11342 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
11343
11344 static void
11345 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
11346 {
11347 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1);
11348 }
11349
11350 static int
11351 parse (void)
11352 {
11353 warnings_issued = 0;
11354 return ada_parse ();
11355 }
11356
11357 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
11358 ada_print_subexp,
11359 ada_operator_length,
11360 ada_op_name,
11361 ada_dump_subexp_body,
11362 ada_evaluate_subexp
11363 };
11364
11365 const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = {
11366 "ada", /* Language name */
11367 language_ada,
11368 range_check_off,
11369 type_check_off,
11370 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
11371 that's not quite what this means. */
11372 array_row_major,
11373 macro_expansion_no,
11374 &ada_exp_descriptor,
11375 parse,
11376 ada_error,
11377 resolve,
11378 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
11379 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
11380 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
11381 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
11382 default_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */
11383 ada_val_print, /* Print a value using appropriate syntax */
11384 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
11385 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
11386 NULL, /* name_of_this */
11387 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
11388 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */
11389 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
11390 NULL, /* Language specific class_name_from_physname */
11391 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
11392 0, /* c-style arrays */
11393 1, /* String lower bound */
11394 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
11395 ada_make_symbol_completion_list,
11396 ada_language_arch_info,
11397 ada_print_array_index,
11398 default_pass_by_reference,
11399 c_get_string,
11400 LANG_MAGIC
11401 };
11402
11403 /* Provide a prototype to silence -Wmissing-prototypes. */
11404 extern initialize_file_ftype _initialize_ada_language;
11405
11406 void
11407 _initialize_ada_language (void)
11408 {
11409 add_language (&ada_language_defn);
11410
11411 varsize_limit = 65536;
11412
11413 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
11414
11415 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc
11416 (256, htab_hash_string, (int (*)(const void *, const void *)) streq,
11417 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
11418
11419 observer_attach_executable_changed (ada_executable_changed_observer);
11420 }